blob: 6f7a99ff612b03906b3103d9be61167654c93048 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreauf08137c2017-10-22 10:13:45 +02007 2017/10/22
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111
1121. Quick reminder about HTTP
113----------------------------
114
115When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
116fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
117on almost anything found in the contents.
118
119However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
120formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
121correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
122
123
1241.1. The HTTP transaction model
125-------------------------------
126
127The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100128to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
130connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
131will involve a new connection :
132
133 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
134
135In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
136establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
137by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
138length.
139
140Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
141to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
142however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
143response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
144header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
149power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
150but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
153A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
154keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
155second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
156page :
157
158 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
159
160This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
161latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
162correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
163the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100164server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
167connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
168leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
169start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100171HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
172 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
173 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
174 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
175 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
176 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
177 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
1801.2. HTTP request
181-----------------
182
183First, let's consider this HTTP request :
184
185 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100186 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
188 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
189 3 User-agent: my small browser
190 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
191 5 Accept: image/png
192
193
1941.2.1. The Request line
195-----------------------
196
197Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
198
199 - a METHOD : GET
200 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
202
203All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
204which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
205followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
206is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
207desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
208the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
209
210The URI itself can have several forms :
211
212 - A "relative URI" :
213
214 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
217 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
218
219 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
220
221 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
222
223 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
224 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
225 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
226 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
227 must accept this form too.
228
229 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
230 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
231 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200233 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
234 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
235 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
236 other protocols too.
237
238In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
239mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
240on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
241It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
242specific to the language, framework or application in use.
243
244
2451.2.2. The request headers
246--------------------------
247
248The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
249beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
250an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
251Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
252values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
253encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
254the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
255define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
256
257Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
258their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
259"Connection:" header).
260
261The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
262that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
263is one valid form of empty line.
264
265Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
266headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
267about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
268application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
269
270Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000271 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200272 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
273 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
274 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
275
276
2771.3. HTTP response
278------------------
279
280An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
281messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
282
283 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100284 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
286 2 Content-length: 350
287 3 Content-Type: text/html
288
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
290codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
291response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100292continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
293the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
294following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
295sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
296(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
297correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
298such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
299state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
300over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
301if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
302information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304
3051.3.1. The Response line
306------------------------
307
308Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
309
310 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
311 - a status code : 200
312 - a reason : OK
313
314The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
317 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
318 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
319 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
320
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000321Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
324messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
325or "Authentication Required".
326
327Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
328
329 Code When / reason
330 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
331 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100334 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
335 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200336 400 for an invalid or too large request
337 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
338 accessing the stats page)
339 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
340 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
341 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
342 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
343 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
344 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
345 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
346 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
347 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
348
349The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3504.2).
351
352
3531.3.2. The response headers
354---------------------------
355
356Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
357the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
358details.
359
360
3612. Configuring HAProxy
362----------------------
363
3642.1. Configuration file format
365------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200366
367HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
368
369 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
370 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
371 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
372 "frontend" and "backend".
373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100374The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
375referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200376delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003792.2. Quoting and escaping
380-------------------------
381
382HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
383many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
384with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
385single quotes.
386
387If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
388them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
389escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
390
391Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
392
393 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
394 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
395 \\ to use a backslash
396 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
397 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
398
399Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
400the interpretation of:
401
402 space as a parameter separator
403 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
404 # hash as a comment start
405
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200406Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
407-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
408backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
409
410Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200411quoting.
412
413Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
414nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
415
416Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
417equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
418
419 Example:
420 # those are equivalents:
421 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
423 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
425 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
426
427 # those are equivalents:
428 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
431 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
432
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004342.3. Environment variables
435--------------------------
436
437HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
438interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
439configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
440optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
441shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
442underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
443
444 Example:
445
446 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
447
448 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
449
450 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
451
452
4532.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200454----------------
455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100456Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100457values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
458otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
459numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
460for every keyword. Supported units are :
461
462 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
463 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
464 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
465 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
466 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
467 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
468
469
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00004702.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200471-------------
472
473 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
474 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
475 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
476 global
477 daemon
478 maxconn 256
479
480 defaults
481 mode http
482 timeout connect 5000ms
483 timeout client 50000ms
484 timeout server 50000ms
485
486 frontend http-in
487 bind *:80
488 default_backend servers
489
490 backend servers
491 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
492
493
494 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
495 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
496 global
497 daemon
498 maxconn 256
499
500 defaults
501 mode http
502 timeout connect 5000ms
503 timeout client 50000ms
504 timeout server 50000ms
505
506 listen http-in
507 bind *:80
508 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
509
510
511Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
512
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100513 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200514
515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005163. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517--------------------
518
519Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
520are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
521of them have command-line equivalents.
522
523The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
524
525 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200528 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200529 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200531 - description
532 - deviceatlas-json-file
533 - deviceatlas-log-level
534 - deviceatlas-separator
535 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900536 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 - gid
538 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100539 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100542 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200545 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200546 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100548 - presetenv
549 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200550 - uid
551 - ulimit-n
552 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100553 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200554 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200555 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
556 - ssl-default-bind-options
557 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
558 - ssl-default-server-options
559 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100560 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100561 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100562 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100563 - 51degrees-data-file
564 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200565 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200566 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100567 - wurfl-data-file
568 - wurfl-information-list
569 - wurfl-information-list-separator
570 - wurfl-engine-mode
571 - wurfl-cache-size
572 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100573
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200575 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200577 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100578 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100579 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100580 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200581 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200582 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200583 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585 - noepoll
586 - nokqueue
587 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100588 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300589 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000590 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200591 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200592 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200593 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000594 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000595 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200596 - tune.buffers.limit
597 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200598 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200599 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100600 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100601 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200602 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200603 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100604 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100605 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100606 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100607 - tune.lua.session-timeout
608 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200609 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100610 - tune.maxaccept
611 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200612 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200613 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200614 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100615 - tune.rcvbuf.client
616 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100617 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100618 - tune.sndbuf.client
619 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100620 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100621 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200622 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100623 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200624 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200625 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100626 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200627 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100628 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200629 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
630 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
631 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100632 - tune.zlib.memlevel
633 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100634
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200635 * Debugging
636 - debug
637 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200638
639
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006403.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200641------------------------------------
642
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200643ca-base <dir>
644 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200645 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
646 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200647
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648chroot <jail dir>
649 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
650 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
651 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
652 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
653 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
654 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100655
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100656cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
657 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
658 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
659 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100660 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
661 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
662 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
663 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
664 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
665 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
666 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
667 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
668 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
669 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100670
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200671crt-base <dir>
672 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
673 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
674 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
675
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200676daemon
677 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
678 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
679 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
680
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200681deviceatlas-json-file <path>
682 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
683 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
684
685deviceatlas-log-level <value>
686 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
687 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
688
689deviceatlas-separator <char>
690 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
691 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
692
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100693deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200694 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
695 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
696 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100697
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900698external-check
699 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
700 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
701 See "option external-check".
702
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200703gid <number>
704 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
705 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
706 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100707 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
708 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200709 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100710
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100711hard-stop-after <time>
712 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
713
714 Arguments :
715 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
716 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
717 SIGUSR1 signal.
718
719 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
720 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
721 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
722
723 Example:
724 global
725 hard-stop-after 30s
726
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200727group <group name>
728 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
729 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100730
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200731log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200732 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
733 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100734 configured with "log global".
735
736 <address> can be one of:
737
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100738 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100739 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
740 port).
741
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100742 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
743 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
744 port).
745
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100746 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
747 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
748 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
749 writeable).
750
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200751 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
752 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100753
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200754 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
755 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
756 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
757 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
758 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
759 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
760 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
761 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
762 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
763 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200764 JSON-formated logs may require larger values. You may also need to
765 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request uris are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200766
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200767 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
768 one of the following :
769
770 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
771 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
772
773 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
774 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
775
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100776 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200777
778 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
779 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
780 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
781
782 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200783 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
784 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
785 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
786 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
787 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
788 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200789
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200790 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200791
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100792log-send-hostname [<string>]
793 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
794 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
795 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
796 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
797 the logs.
798
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000799log-tag <string>
800 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
801 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
802 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100803 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000804
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100805lua-load <file>
806 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
807 used multiple times.
808
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200809master-worker [exit-on-failure]
810 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
811 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
812 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
813 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
814 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
815 systemd.
816 The "exit-on-failure" option allows the master to kill every workers and
817 exit when one of the current workers died. It is convenient to combine this
818 option with Restart=on-failure in a systemd unit file in order to relaunch
819 the whole process.
820
821 See alors "-W" in the management guide.
822
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823nbproc <number>
824 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
825 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
826 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
827 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
828 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
829
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200830nbthread <number>
831 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
832 creates <number> threads for each created processes. It means if HAProxy is
833 started in foreground, it only creates <number> threads for the first
834 process. FOR NOW, THREADS SUPPORT IN HAPROXY IS HIGHLY EXPERIMENTAL AND IT
835 MUST BE ENABLED WITH CAUTION AND AT YOUR OWN RISK. See also "nbproc".
836
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200837pidfile <pidfile>
838 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
839 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
840 starting the process. See also "daemon".
841
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100842presetenv <name> <value>
843 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
844 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
845 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
846 and "unsetenv".
847
848resetenv [<name> ...]
849 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
850 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
851 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
852 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
853 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
854 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
855 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
856 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
857
Olivier Houchard9679ac92017-10-27 14:58:08 +0200858ssl-allow-0rtt
859 Allow using 0RTT on every listener. 0RTT is prone to various attacks, so be
860 sure to know the security implications before activating it.
861
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100862stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200863 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
864 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
865 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
866 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
867 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
868 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100869 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200870 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
871 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200872
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200873server-state-base <directory>
874 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200875 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
876 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200877
878server-state-file <file>
879 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
880 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
881 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
882 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
883 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
884 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
885 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
886 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200887 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
888 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200889
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100890setenv <name> <value>
891 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
892 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
893 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
894 and "unsetenv".
895
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100896ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
897 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
898 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300899 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100900 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
901 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
902 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
903 "bind" keyword for more information.
904
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100905ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
906 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
907 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
908 keyword to see available options.
909
910 Example:
911 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +0200912 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100913
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100914ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
915 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
916 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300917 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100918 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
919 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
920 information.
921
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100922ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
923 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
924 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
925 keyword to see available options.
926
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200927ssl-dh-param-file <file>
928 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
929 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
930 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
931 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
932 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200933 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
934 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
935 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
936 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200937 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
938 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
939 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
940
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100941ssl-server-verify [none|required]
942 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
943 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
944 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
945
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200946stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
947 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
948 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
949 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +0200950 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200951 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200952
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200953 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
954 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
955 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200956
957stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
958 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
959 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100960 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200961
962stats maxconn <connections>
963 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
964 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
965
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200966uid <number>
967 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
968 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
969 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
970 one. See also "gid" and "user".
971
972ulimit-n <number>
973 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
974 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
975 option.
976
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100977unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
978 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
979
980 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
981 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
982 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
983 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
984 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
985 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
986 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
987 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
988 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
989 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
990
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100991unsetenv [<name> ...]
992 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
993 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
994 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
995 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
996 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
997 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
998 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
999
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001000user <user name>
1001 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1002 See also "uid" and "group".
1003
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001004node <name>
1005 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1006
1007 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1008 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1009 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1010 traffic.
1011
1012description <text>
1013 Add a text that describes the instance.
1014
1015 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1016 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1017 "<" and ">" characters.
1018
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100101951degrees-data-file <file path>
1020 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1021 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
1022
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001023 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001024 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1025
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000102651degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001027 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1028 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1029 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1030
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001031 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001032 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1033
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200103451degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001035 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1036 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1037
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001038 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1039 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1040
104151degrees-cache-size <number>
1042 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1043 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1044 By default, this cache is disabled.
1045
1046 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001047 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1048
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001049wurfl-data-file <file path>
1050 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1051 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1052
1053 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1054 with USE_WURFL=1.
1055
1056wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1057 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1058 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1059 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1060
1061 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1062
1063 Valid WURFL properties are:
1064 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1065
1066 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1067 device.
1068
1069 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1070 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1071
1072 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1073 particular web request.
1074
1075 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1076 used Libwurfl API version.
1077
1078 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1079 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1080 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1081
1082 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1083 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1084
1085 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1086 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1087
1088 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1089
1090 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1091
1092 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1093 with USE_WURFL=1.
1094
1095wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1096 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1097 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1098
1099 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1100 with USE_WURFL=1.
1101
1102wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1103 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1104 thus before the chroot.
1105
1106 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1107 with USE_WURFL=1.
1108
1109wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1110 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1111 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1112 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1113 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1114 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1115 mode is enabled by default.
1116
1117 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1118 with USE_WURFL=1.
1119
1120wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1121 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1122 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1123 - "0" : no cache is used.
1124 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1125 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1126 the highest performing option.
1127
1128 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1129 with USE_WURFL=1.
1130
1131wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1132 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1133 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1134
1135 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1136 with USE_WURFL=1.
1137
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001138
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011393.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001140-----------------------
1141
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001142max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1143 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1144 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1145 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1146 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1147 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1148 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1149 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1150 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1151
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001152maxconn <number>
1153 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1154 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1155 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001156 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1157 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1158 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1159 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001160 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1161 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1162 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1163 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1164 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001165
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001166maxconnrate <number>
1167 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1168 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1169 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1170 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1171 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1172 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1173 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1174 fairness.
1175
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001176maxcomprate <number>
1177 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001178 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001179 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1180 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1181 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1182 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1183 default value.
1184
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001185maxcompcpuusage <number>
1186 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1187 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1188 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1189 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1190 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1191 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1192 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1193 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1194
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001195maxpipes <number>
1196 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1197 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1198 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1199 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1200 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1201 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1202
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001203maxsessrate <number>
1204 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1205 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1206 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1207 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1208 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1209 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1210 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1211 fairness.
1212
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001213maxsslconn <number>
1214 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1215 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1216 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1217 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1218 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1219 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1220 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001221 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1222 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1223 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1224 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1225 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1226 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1227 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001228
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001229maxsslrate <number>
1230 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1231 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1232 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1233 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1234 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1235 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1236 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1237 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1238 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1239 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1240
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001241maxzlibmem <number>
1242 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1243 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1244 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001245 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1246 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1247 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1248
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001249noepoll
1250 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1251 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001252 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001253
1254nokqueue
1255 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1256 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1257 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1258
1259nopoll
1260 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1261 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001262 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001263 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001264
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001265nosplice
1266 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1267 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1268 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001269 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001270 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1271 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1272 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1273 "option splice-response".
1274
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001275nogetaddrinfo
1276 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1277 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1278
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001279noreuseport
1280 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1281 command line argument "-dR".
1282
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001283spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001284 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1285 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1286 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1287 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1288 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1289 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001290
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001291ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-seperated list of algorithms>]
1292 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
1293 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
1294 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1295 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1296 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1297 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1298 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
1299 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1300 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-seperated list
1301 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1302 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1303 openssl configuration file uses:
1304 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1305
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001306ssl-mode-async
1307 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001308 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001309 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1310 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1311 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1312 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1313 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001314
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001315tune.buffers.limit <number>
1316 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1317 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1318 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1319 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1320 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1321 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1322 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1323 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1324 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1325 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1326 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1327 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1328 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1329 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1330 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1331
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001332tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1333 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1334 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1335 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1336 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1337
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001338tune.bufsize <number>
1339 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1340 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1341 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1342 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1343 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1344 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1345 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1346 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001347 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1348 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1349 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001350
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001351tune.chksize <number>
1352 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1353 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1354 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1355 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1356 checks whenever possible.
1357
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001358tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1359 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1360 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1361 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1362 this value. The default value is 1.
1363
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001364tune.http.cookielen <number>
1365 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1366 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1367 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1368 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1369 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1370 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1371 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1372 to change this value.
1373
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001374tune.http.logurilen <number>
1375 Sets the maximum length of request uri in logs. This prevent to truncate long
1376 requests uris with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
1377 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
1378 'log ... len yyyy' parameter. Your syslog deamon may also need specific
1379 configuration directives too.
1380 The default value is 1024.
1381
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001382tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1383 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1384 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1385 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1386 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1387 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1388 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001389 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1390 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1391 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001392
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001393tune.idletimer <timeout>
1394 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1395 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1396 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1397 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1398 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1399 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1400 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1401 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1402 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1403
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001404tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1405 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001406 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001407 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1408 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1409 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1410 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1411 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1412
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001413tune.lua.maxmem
1414 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1415 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1416 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1417 memory.
1418
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001419tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1420 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001421 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1422 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1423 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001424
1425tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1426 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1427 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1428 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1429 check servers.
1430
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001431tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1432 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1433 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1434 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1435 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1436
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001437tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001438 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1439 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1440 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1441 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1442 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1443 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1444 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1445 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1446 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1447 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001448
1449tune.maxpollevents <number>
1450 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1451 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1452 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1453 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1454 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1455
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001456tune.maxrewrite <number>
1457 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1458 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1459 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1460 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1461 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1462 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1463 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1464 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1465 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1466 bufsize.
1467
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001468tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1469 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1470 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1471 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1472 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1473 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1474 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1475 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1476 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1477 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1478 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1479 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1480 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1481 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1482 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1483 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1484 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1485 setting this parameter to 0.
1486
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001487tune.pipesize <number>
1488 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1489 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1490 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1491 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1492 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1493 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1494
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001495tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1496tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1497 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1498 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1499 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1500 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1501 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1502 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1503 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1504
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001505tune.recv_enough <number>
1506 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1507 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1508 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1509 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1510 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1511
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001512tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1513tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1514 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1515 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1516 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1517 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1518 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1519 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1520 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1521 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1522 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1523 notifying haproxy again.
1524
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001525tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001526 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1527 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1528 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001529 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001530 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1531 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1532 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1533 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1534 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001535 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1536 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001537
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001538tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1539 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1540 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1541 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1542 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1543 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1544 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1545
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001546tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1547 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001548 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001549 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1550 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1551 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1552 being used for too long.
1553
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001554tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1555 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1556 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1557 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1558 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1559 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1560 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1561 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1562 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1563 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1564 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001565 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1566 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001567
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001568tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1569 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1570 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1571 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1572 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1573 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1574 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1575 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001576 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1577 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001578
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001579tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1580 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1581 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1582 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1583 1000 entries.
1584
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001585tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1586 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1587 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1588 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1589
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001590tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001591tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001592tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1593tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1594tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001595 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1596 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1597 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1598 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1599 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1600 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1601 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1602 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001603
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001604 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1605 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1606 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1607 all available space is consumed.
1608 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1609 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1610 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001611
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001612tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1613 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001614 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001615 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1616 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1617 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1618
1619tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1620 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1621 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1622 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1623 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016253.3. Debugging
1626--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001627
1628debug
1629 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1630 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1631 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1632 system startup.
1633
1634quiet
1635 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1636 line argument "-q".
1637
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001638
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016393.4. Userlists
1640--------------
1641It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1642http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1643it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1644
1645userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001646 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001647 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1648
1649group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001650 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001651 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1652 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1653
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001654user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1655 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001656 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1657 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001658 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1659 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001660 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001661 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001662
1663
1664 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001665 userlist L1
1666 group G1 users tiger,scott
1667 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001668
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001669 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1670 user scott insecure-password elgato
1671 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001672
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001673 userlist L2
1674 group G1
1675 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001676
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001677 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1678 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1679 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001680
1681 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001682
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001683
16843.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001685----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001686It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1687several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1688instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1689values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1690automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1691In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1692using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1693tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1694reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1695Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1696that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1697each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001698
1699peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001700 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001701 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1702
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001703disabled
1704 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1705 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1706 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1707
1708enable
1709 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1710
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001711peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1712 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1713 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1714 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1715 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1716 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1717 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1718
1719 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1720 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1721
1722 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1723 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1724 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1725 across all peers.
1726
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001727 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1728 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001729
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001730 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001731 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001732 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1733 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1734 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001735
1736 backend mybackend
1737 mode tcp
1738 balance roundrobin
1739 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1740 stick on src
1741
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001742 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1743 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001744
1745
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090017463.6. Mailers
1747------------
1748It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1749If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1750in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1751
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001752mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001753 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1754 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1755
1756mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1757 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1758
1759 Example:
1760 mailers mymailers
1761 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1762 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1763
1764 backend mybackend
1765 mode tcp
1766 balance roundrobin
1767
1768 email-alert mailers mymailers
1769 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1770 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1771
1772 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1773 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1774
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001775timeout mail <time>
1776 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1777 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1778 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1779 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1780
1781 Example:
1782 mailers mymailers
1783 timeout mail 20s
1784 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017864. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001787----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001788
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001789Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001790 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001791 - frontend <name>
1792 - backend <name>
1793 - listen <name>
1794
1795A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1796its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1797section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001798section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001799
1800A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1801connections.
1802
1803A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1804to forward incoming connections.
1805
1806A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1807parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1808
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001809All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1810'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1811case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1812
1813Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1814logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1815proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1816However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1817name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1818
1819Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1820and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001821bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001822protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1823modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1824arbitrary criteria.
1825
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001826In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1827a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1828the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1829
1830 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1831 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1832 between responses and new requests.
1833
1834 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1835 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1836 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1837 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1838
1839 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1840 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1841 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1842
1843 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1844 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1845 client-facing connection remains open.
1846
1847 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1848 after the end of the response.
1849
1850The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1851frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1852following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1853weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1854
1855 Backend mode
1856
1857 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1858 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1859 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1860 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1861 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1862 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1863 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1864 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1865 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1866 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1867 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1868
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001869
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001870
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018714.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1872--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001873
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001874The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1875limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1876they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1877limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001878marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001879option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001880and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1881with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1882specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001883
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001884
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001885 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1886------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1887acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001888appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001889backlog X X X -
1890balance X - X X
1891bind - X X -
1892bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02001893block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001894capture cookie - X X -
1895capture request header - X X -
1896capture response header - X X -
1897clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001898compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001899contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1900cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001901declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001902default-server X - X X
1903default_backend X X X -
1904description - X X X
1905disabled X X X X
1906dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001907email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001908email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001909email-alert mailers X X X X
1910email-alert myhostname X X X X
1911email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001912enabled X X X X
1913errorfile X X X X
1914errorloc X X X X
1915errorloc302 X X X X
1916-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1917errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001918force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001919filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001920fullconn X - X X
1921grace X X X X
1922hash-type X - X X
1923http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001924http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001925http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001926http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001927http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001928http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001929http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001930id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001931ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001932load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001933log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001934log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001935log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001936log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001937max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001938maxconn X X X -
1939mode X X X X
1940monitor fail - X X -
1941monitor-net X X X -
1942monitor-uri X X X -
1943option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1944option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1945option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1946option allbackups (*) X - X X
1947option checkcache (*) X - X X
1948option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1949option contstats (*) X X X -
1950option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1951option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1952option forceclose (*) X X X X
1953-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1954option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001955option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001956option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001957option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001958option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001959option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001960option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001961option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001962option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1963option httpchk X - X X
1964option httpclose (*) X X X X
1965option httplog X X X X
1966option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001967option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001968option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001969option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001970option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1971option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1972option logasap (*) X X X -
1973option mysql-check X - X X
1974option nolinger (*) X X X X
1975option originalto X X X X
1976option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001977option pgsql-check X - X X
1978option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001979option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001980option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001981option smtpchk X - X X
1982option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1983option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1984option splice-request (*) X X X X
1985option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01001986option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001987option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1988option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1989-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001990option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001991option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1992option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1993option tcpka X X X X
1994option tcplog X X X X
1995option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001996external-check command X - X X
1997external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001998persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1999rate-limit sessions X X X -
2000redirect - X X X
2001redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2002redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2003reqadd - X X X
2004reqallow - X X X
2005reqdel - X X X
2006reqdeny - X X X
2007reqiallow - X X X
2008reqidel - X X X
2009reqideny - X X X
2010reqipass - X X X
2011reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002012reqitarpit - X X X
2013reqpass - X X X
2014reqrep - X X X
2015-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002016reqtarpit - X X X
2017retries X - X X
2018rspadd - X X X
2019rspdel - X X X
2020rspdeny - X X X
2021rspidel - X X X
2022rspideny - X X X
2023rspirep - X X X
2024rsprep - X X X
2025server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002026server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002027server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002028source X - X X
2029srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002030stats admin - X X X
2031stats auth X X X X
2032stats enable X X X X
2033stats hide-version X X X X
2034stats http-request - X X X
2035stats realm X X X X
2036stats refresh X X X X
2037stats scope X X X X
2038stats show-desc X X X X
2039stats show-legends X X X X
2040stats show-node X X X X
2041stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002042-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2043stick match - - X X
2044stick on - - X X
2045stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002046stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002047stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002048tcp-check connect - - X X
2049tcp-check expect - - X X
2050tcp-check send - - X X
2051tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002052tcp-request connection - X X -
2053tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002054tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002055tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002056tcp-response content - - X X
2057tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002058timeout check X - X X
2059timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002060timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002061timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2062timeout connect X - X X
2063timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2064timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2065timeout http-request X X X X
2066timeout queue X - X X
2067timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002068timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002069timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2070timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002071timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002072transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002073unique-id-format X X X -
2074unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002075use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002076use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002077------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2078 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002079
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002080
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020814.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2082---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002083
2084This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2085
2086
2087acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2088 Declare or complete an access list.
2089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2090 no | yes | yes | yes
2091 Example:
2092 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2093 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2094 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002096 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002097
2098
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002099appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2100 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002101 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2103 no | no | yes | yes
2104 Arguments :
2105 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2106 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2107
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002108 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002109 checked in each cookie value.
2110
2111 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2112 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2113 milliseconds.
2114
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002115 request-learn
2116 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2117 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2118 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2119 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2120 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2121 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2122
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002123 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2124 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2125 data following this prefix.
2126
2127 Example :
2128 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2129
2130 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2131 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2132
2133 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2134 2 modes are currently supported :
2135 - path-parameters :
2136 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2137 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2138 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2139 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2140 - query-string :
2141 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2142 query string.
2143
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002144 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2145 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2146 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002147
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002148 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2149 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002150
2151
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002152backlog <conns>
2153 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2155 yes | yes | yes | no
2156 Arguments :
2157 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2158 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002159 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002160
2161 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2162 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2163 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2164 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2165 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2166 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2167 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2168 backlog parameter.
2169
2170 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2171 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2172 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2173
2174 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2175
2176
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002177balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002178balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002179 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2181 yes | no | yes | yes
2182 Arguments :
2183 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2184 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2185 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2186 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2187
2188 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2189 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2190 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2191 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002192 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002193 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002194 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2195 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2196 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2197 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2198 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2199 it, so that you don't worry.
2200
2201 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2202 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2203 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2204 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2205 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2206 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2207 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2208 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002209
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002210 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2211 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2212 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2213 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2214 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2215 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2216 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2217 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2218
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002219 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002220 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002221 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2222 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002223 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002224 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2225 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2226 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2227 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2228 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002229 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2230 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2231 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2232 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2233 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2234 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002235
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002236 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2237 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2238 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2239 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2240 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2241 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2242 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2243 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002244 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002245 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002246 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2247 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2248 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002249
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002250 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2251 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2252 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2253 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2254 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2255 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2256 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2257 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2258 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2259 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2260 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2261 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002262
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002263 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002264 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2265 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2266 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2267 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2268 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2269 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2270 URIs start with a leading "/".
2271
2272 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2273 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2274 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2275 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2276
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002277 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002278 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2279
2280 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002281 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2282 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002283 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2284 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2285 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2286 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002287 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002288 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2289 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002290
2291 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2292 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2293 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2294 server will receive the request.
2295
2296 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2297 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2298 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2299 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2300 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002301 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2302 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2303 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002304
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002305 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2306 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2307 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2308 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2309 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002310
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002311 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002312 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2313 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2314 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2315
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002316 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2317 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2318 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2319
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002320 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002321 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002322 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2323 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2324 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2325 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2326 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2327 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002328 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002329 used instead.
2330
2331 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2332 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2333 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2334 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2335
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002336 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2337 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2338 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2339
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002340 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002341
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002342 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002343 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2344 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002345
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002346 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2347 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2348 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002349
2350 Examples :
2351 balance roundrobin
2352 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002353 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002354 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2355 balance hdr(host)
2356 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002357
2358 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2359 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2360
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002361 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002362 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2363 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2364 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2365 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2366
2367 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2368 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2369 defaults to 16 kB.
2370
2371 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2372 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2373
2374 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2375 Round Robin.
2376
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002377 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002378 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2379 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2380 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2381
2382 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2383
2384 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002385 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002386 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2387 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2388 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002389
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002390 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002391
2392
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002393bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2394bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002395 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2397 no | yes | yes | no
2398 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002399 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2400 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2401 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2402 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002403 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002404 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2405 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2406 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2407 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2408 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2409 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2410 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002411 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2412 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2413 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2414 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2415 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2416 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2417 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002418 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2419 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2420 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002421 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2422 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2423 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002424
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002425 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2426 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002427 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2428 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2429 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002430 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2431 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2432 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2433 the range.
2434
2435 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2436 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2437 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2438 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2439 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2440 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2441 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002442 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002443 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002444
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002445 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2446 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2447 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2448 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2449 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2450 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2451 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2452 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2453
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002454 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2455 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2456 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2457 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002458
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002459 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2460 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2461 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2462 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2463 in a frontend.
2464
2465 Example :
2466 listen http_proxy
2467 bind :80,:443
2468 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002469 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002470
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002471 listen http_https_proxy
2472 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002473 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002474
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002475 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2476 bind ipv6@:80
2477 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2478 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2479
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002480 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002481 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002482
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002483 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2484 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2485 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2486 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2487 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2488
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002489 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002490 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002491
2492
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002493bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002494 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2496 yes | yes | yes | yes
2497 Arguments :
2498 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2499 may be used to override a default value.
2500
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002501 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002502 option may be combined with other numbers.
2503
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002504 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002505 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2506 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2507 missing from all processes.
2508
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002509 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002510 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002511 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2512 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2513 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2514 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002515
2516 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2517 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2518 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2519 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2520 and 'even' instances.
2521
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002522 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2523 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2524 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2525 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002526
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002527 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2528 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2529
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002530 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2531 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2532 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2533
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002534 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2535 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2536
2537 Example :
2538 listen app_ip1
2539 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002540 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002541
2542 listen app_ip2
2543 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002544 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002545
2546 listen management
2547 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002548 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002549
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002550 listen management
2551 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2552 bind-process 1-4
2553
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002554 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002555
2556
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002557block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002558 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2560 no | yes | yes | yes
2561
2562 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2563 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002564 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002565 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002566 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002567 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2568 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2569 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002570
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002571 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2572 "http-request deny" instead.
2573
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002574 Example:
2575 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2576 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2577 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002578 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2579 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2580 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002581
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002582 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2583 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2584 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002585
2586capture cookie <name> len <length>
2587 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2589 no | yes | yes | no
2590 Arguments :
2591 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2592 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2593 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2594 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2595 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2596
2597 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2598 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2599 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2600 right if it exceeds <length>.
2601
2602 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2603 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2604 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2605 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2606
2607 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2608 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2609 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2610
2611 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2612 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2613 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002614 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2615 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2616 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002617
2618 Example:
2619 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2620
2621 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002622 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002623
2624
2625capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002626 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2628 no | yes | yes | no
2629 Arguments :
2630 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002631 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002632 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2633 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2634 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2635
2636 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2637 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2638 it exceeds <length>.
2639
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002640 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002641 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2642 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002643 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2644 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2645 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2646 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002647 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002648 environments to find where the request came from.
2649
2650 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2651 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2652 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2653 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002654
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002655 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2656 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2657 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2658 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2659 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002660
2661 Example:
2662 capture request header Host len 15
2663 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002664 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002665
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002666 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002667 about logging.
2668
2669
2670capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002671 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2673 no | yes | yes | no
2674 Arguments :
2675 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002676 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002677 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2678 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2679 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2680
2681 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2682 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2683 it exceeds <length>.
2684
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002685 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002686 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2687 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2688 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002689 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2690 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2691 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2692 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002693
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002694 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2695 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2696 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2697 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2698 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002699
2700 Example:
2701 capture response header Content-length len 9
2702 capture response header Location len 15
2703
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002704 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002705 about logging.
2706
2707
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002708clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002709 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2711 yes | yes | yes | no
2712 Arguments :
2713 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2714 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2715 as explained at the top of this document.
2716
2717 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2718 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2719 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2720 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2721 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2722 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2723 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2724 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002725 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002726 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2727 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2728
2729 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2730 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2731 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2732 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2733 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2734 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2735
2736 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2737 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2738
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002739 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2740 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002741
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002742compression algo <algorithm> ...
2743compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002744compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002745 Enable HTTP compression.
2746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2747 yes | yes | yes | yes
2748 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002749 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2750 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2751 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2752
2753 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002754 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2755 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2756 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002757
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002758 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002759 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002760
2761 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2762 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2763 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2764 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2765 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002766 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002767
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002768 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2769 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2770 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2771 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2772 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2773 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2774 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002775 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002776
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002777 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002778 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002779 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2780 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2781 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2782 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2783 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002784
2785 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2786 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2787 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2788 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2789 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002790 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2791 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2792 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2793 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2794 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002795 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2796 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002797
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002798 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002799 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2800 "Accept-Encoding" header
2801 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002802 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002803 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2804 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002805 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2806 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2807 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2808 "multipart"
2809 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2810 header
2811 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2812 and later
2813 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2814 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002815
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002816 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2817 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002818
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002819 Examples :
2820 compression algo gzip
2821 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002822
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002823
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002824contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002825 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2827 yes | no | yes | yes
2828 Arguments :
2829 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2830 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2831 as explained at the top of this document.
2832
2833 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002834 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002835 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002836 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2837 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2838 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2839 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2840
2841 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2842 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2843 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2844 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2845 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2846 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2847
2848 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2849 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2850 instead.
2851
2852 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2853 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2854
2855
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002856cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002857 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2858 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002859 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002860 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2862 yes | no | yes | yes
2863 Arguments :
2864 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2865 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2866 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2867 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2868 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2869 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2870 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2871 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2872 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2873
2874 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2875 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2876 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2877 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2878 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2879 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002880 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2881 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2882 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2883 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2884 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002885
2886 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002887 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002888
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002889 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002890 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2891 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2892 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2893 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2894 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2895 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2896 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2897 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2898 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2899 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002900
2901 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2902 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2903 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2904 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2905 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2906 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2907 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2908 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2909 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002910 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002911 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2912 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2913 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002914
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002915 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2916 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2917 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002918 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2919 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2920 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2921 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002922 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2923 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2924 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002925
2926 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2927 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2928 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2929 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2930 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2931 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2932 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2933 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2934 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2935
2936 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2937 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2938 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2939 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2940 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2941 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2942 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2943 persistence cookie in the cache.
2944 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2945
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002946 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2947 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2948 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2949 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2950 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2951 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2952 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2953 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2954 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2955 they logout.
2956
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002957 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2958 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2959 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2960 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2961
2962 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2963 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2964 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2965 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2966 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2967 this attribute.
2968
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002969 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002970 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002971 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2972 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2973 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2974 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2975 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2976 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002977
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002978 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2979 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2980 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2981 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2982 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2983 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2984 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2985 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2986 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2987 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2988 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2989 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2990 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2991 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2992 the site.
2993
2994 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2995 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2996 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2997 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2998 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2999 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3000 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3001 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3002 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3003 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3004 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3005 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3006 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
3007 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
3008 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3009 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3010
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003011 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3012 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3013 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3014 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3015 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3016 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3017
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003018 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3019 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3020 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3021 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003022
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003023 Examples :
3024 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3025 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3026 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003027 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003028
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003029 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003030
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003031
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003032declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3033 Declares a capture slot.
3034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3035 no | yes | yes | no
3036 Arguments:
3037 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3038
3039 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3040 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3041 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3042 for use in the response.
3043
3044 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003045 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003046 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3047
3048
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003049default-server [param*]
3050 Change default options for a server in a backend
3051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3052 yes | no | yes | yes
3053 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003054 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3055 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3056 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3057 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003058
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003059 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003060 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3061
3062 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003063
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003064
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003065default_backend <backend>
3066 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3068 yes | yes | yes | no
3069 Arguments :
3070 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3071
3072 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3073 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3074 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3075 will catch all undetermined requests.
3076
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003077 Example :
3078
3079 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3080 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3081 default_backend dynamic
3082
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003083 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003084
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003085
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003086description <string>
3087 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3089 no | yes | yes | yes
3090 Arguments : string
3091
3092 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3093 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3094 it describes.
3095 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3096
3097
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003098disabled
3099 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3101 yes | yes | yes | yes
3102 Arguments : none
3103
3104 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3105 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3106 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3107 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3108 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3109 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3110 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3111
3112 See also : "enabled"
3113
3114
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003115dispatch <address>:<port>
3116 Set a default server address
3117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3118 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003119 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003120
3121 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3122 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3123 during start-up.
3124
3125 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3126 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3127 possible with normal servers.
3128
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003129 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003130 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3131 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3132 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3133 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3134
3135 See also : "server"
3136
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003137
3138dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3139 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3141 yes | no | yes | yes
3142 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3143
3144 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
3145 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitely
3146 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3147 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
3148 That way, we can ensure session persistence accross multiple load-balancers,
3149 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003150
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003151enabled
3152 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3154 yes | yes | yes | yes
3155 Arguments : none
3156
3157 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3158 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3159
3160 See also : "disabled"
3161
3162
3163errorfile <code> <file>
3164 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3166 yes | yes | yes | yes
3167 Arguments :
3168 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003169 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3170 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003171
3172 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003173 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003174 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003175 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3176 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003177
3178 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3179 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3180 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3181
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003182 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3183
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003184 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3185 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3186 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3187 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3188
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003189 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3190 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3191 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3192 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3193 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3194 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3195
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003196 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3197 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3198 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003199 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003200 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3201
3202 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3203
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003204 Example :
3205 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003206 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003207 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3208 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3209
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003210
3211errorloc <code> <url>
3212errorloc302 <code> <url>
3213 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3215 yes | yes | yes | yes
3216 Arguments :
3217 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003218 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3219 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003220
3221 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3222 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3223 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3224 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3225 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3226
3227 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3228 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3229 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3230
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003231 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3232
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003233 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3234 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3235 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3236 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003237 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003238 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3239 request.
3240
3241 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3242
3243
3244errorloc303 <code> <url>
3245 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3247 yes | yes | yes | yes
3248 Arguments :
3249 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003250 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3251 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003252
3253 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3254 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3255 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3256 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3257 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3258
3259 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3260 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3261 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3262
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003263 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3264
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003265 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3266 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3267 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3268 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003269 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003270
3271 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3272
3273
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003274email-alert from <emailaddr>
3275 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3276 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3277 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3278 yes | yes | yes | yes
3279
3280 Arguments :
3281
3282 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3283
3284 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3285 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3286
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003287 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003288 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3289 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003290
3291
3292email-alert level <level>
3293 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3294 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3295 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3296 yes | yes | yes | yes
3297
3298 Arguments :
3299
3300 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3301 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3302 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3303
3304 By default level is alert
3305
3306 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3307 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3308 for the proxy.
3309
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003310 Alerts are sent when :
3311
3312 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3313 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3314 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3315 is notice or lower
3316 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3317 and a health check status update occurs
3318
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003319 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3320 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003321 section 3.6 about mailers.
3322
3323
3324email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3325 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3326 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3327 yes | yes | yes | yes
3328
3329 Arguments :
3330
3331 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3332
3333 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3334 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3335
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003336 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3337 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003338
3339
3340email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3341 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3342 mailers.
3343 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3344 yes | yes | yes | yes
3345
3346 Arguments :
3347
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003348 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003349
3350 By default the systems hostname is used.
3351
3352 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3353 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3354 for the proxy.
3355
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003356 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3357 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003358
3359
3360email-alert to <emailaddr>
3361 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3362 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3363 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3364 yes | yes | yes | yes
3365
3366 Arguments :
3367
3368 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3369
3370 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3371 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3372
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003373 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003374 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3375
3376
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003377force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3378 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3379 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3380 no | yes | yes | yes
3381
3382 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3383 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3384 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3385 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3386 marked down for maintenance operations.
3387
3388 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3389 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3390 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3391 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3392 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3393 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3394 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3395 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3396 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3397
3398 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3399 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3400 is used.
3401
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003402 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003403 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003404
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003405
3406filter <name> [param*]
3407 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3409 no | yes | yes | yes
3410 Arguments :
3411 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3412 referenced in section 9.
3413
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003414 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003415 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003416 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3417 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003418
3419 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3420 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3421
3422 Example:
3423 listen
3424 bind *:80
3425
3426 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3427 filter compression
3428 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3429
3430 compression algo gzip
3431 compression offload
3432
3433 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3434
3435 See also : section 9.
3436
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003437
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003438fullconn <conns>
3439 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3441 yes | no | yes | yes
3442 Arguments :
3443 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3444 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3445
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003446 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003447 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003448 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003449 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3450 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3451 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3452 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3453 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003454 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003455
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003456 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3457 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003458 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3459 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3460 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003461
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003462 Example :
3463 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3464 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3465 # connections.
3466 backend dynamic
3467 fullconn 10000
3468 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3469 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3470
3471 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3472
3473
3474grace <time>
3475 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003477 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003478 Arguments :
3479 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3480 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3481 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3482
3483 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3484 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003485 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003486 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3487
3488 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3489 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3490 simplify it.
3491
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003492
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003493hash-balance-factor <factor>
3494 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3496 yes | no | no | yes
3497 Arguments :
3498 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3499 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3500 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3501
3502 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3503 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3504 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3505 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3506 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3507 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3508 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3509
3510 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3511 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3512 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3513 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3514 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3515
3516 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3517
3518
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003519hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003520 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3522 yes | no | yes | yes
3523 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003524 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3525 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003526
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003527 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3528 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3529 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3530 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3531 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3532 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3533 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3534 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3535 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3536 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003537
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003538 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3539 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3540 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3541 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3542 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3543 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3544 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3545 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3546 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3547 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3548 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3549 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3550 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003551 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3552 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003553
3554 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3555
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003556 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003557 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3558 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3559 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003560 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3561 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3562 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003563
3564 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3565 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003566 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3567 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3568 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3569 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3570
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003571 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3572 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3573 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3574 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3575 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3576 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3577 parameter.
3578
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003579 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3580 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3581 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3582 used on strings.
3583
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003584 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3585
3586 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3587 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3588 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3589 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3590 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3591 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3592 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3593 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3594 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3595 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3596 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3597 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003598
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003599 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3600 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3601 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003602
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003603 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003604
3605
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003606http-check disable-on-404
3607 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003609 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003610 Arguments : none
3611
3612 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3613 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3614 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3615 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3616 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3617 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3618 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3619 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003620 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3621 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3622 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3623
3624 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3625
3626
3627http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003628 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003630 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003631 Arguments :
3632 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3633 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003634 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003635 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3636 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3637 details on the supported keywords.
3638
3639 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3640 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3641 with the usual backslash ('\').
3642
3643 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3644 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3645 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3646 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3647 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3648
3649 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003650 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003651 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3652 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3653 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3654
3655 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003656 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003657 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3658 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3659 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3660 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3661
3662 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003663 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003664 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3665 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3666 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3667 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3668 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3669 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3670 trace).
3671
3672 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003673 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003674 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3675 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3676 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3677 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3678 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3679 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3680
3681 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3682 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3683 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3684 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3685 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3686 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3687 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3688 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3689
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003690 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3691 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3692 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3693
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003694 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3695 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3696
3697 Examples :
3698 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003699 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003700
3701 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003702 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003703
3704 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003705 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003706
3707 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003708 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003709
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003710 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003711
3712
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003713http-check send-state
3714 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3716 yes | no | yes | yes
3717 Arguments : none
3718
3719 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3720 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3721 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3722 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3723 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3724
3725 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3726 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3727 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3728 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3729 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003730 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3731 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3732 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3733
3734 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3735 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3736 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3737
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003738 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3739 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3740 checked in multiple backends.
3741
3742 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3743 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3744
3745 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3746 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3747 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3748 one fails.
3749
3750 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3751 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3752 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3753
3754 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3755 server's queue.
3756
3757 Example of a header received by the application server :
3758 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3759 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3760
3761 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3762
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003763http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3764 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003765 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003766 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003767 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003768 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3769 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003770 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3771 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003772 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3773 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3774 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003775 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003776 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003777 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003778 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003779 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003780 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003781 silent-drop |
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02003782 send-spoe-group
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003783 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003784 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003785 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3786
3787 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3788 no | yes | yes | yes
3789
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003790 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3791 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3792 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3793 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3794 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003795
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003796 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3797 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3798 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3799
3800 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003801 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3802 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3803 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3804 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003805
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003806 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3807 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3808 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003809 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3810 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003811 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3812 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3813 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3814 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3815 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003816 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003817 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3818 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003819
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003820 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3821 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3822 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3823 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3824 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3825
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003826 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3827 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3828 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003829 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3830 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003831
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003832 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3833 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3834 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3835 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3836 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3837 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3838 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3839 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3840
3841 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3842 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3843 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003844 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3845 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003846
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003847 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3848 <name>.
3849
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003850 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3851 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3852 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3853 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3854 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3855 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3856 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3857 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3858
3859 Example:
3860
3861 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3862
3863 applied to:
3864
3865 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3866
3867 outputs:
3868
3869 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3870
3871 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3872
3873 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3874 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3875 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3876 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3877 header.
3878
3879 Example:
3880
3881 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3882
3883 applied to:
3884
3885 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3886
3887 outputs:
3888
3889 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3890
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003891 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3892 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3893 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3894 it.
3895
3896 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3897 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3898 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3899 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3900 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3901 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3902
3903 Example :
3904 # prepend the host name before the path
3905 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3906
3907 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3908 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3909 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3910 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3911 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3912 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3913 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3914 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3915
3916 Example :
3917 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3918 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3919
3920 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3921 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3922 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3923 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3924 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3925 "set-query".
3926
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003927 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3928 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3929 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3930 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3931 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3932 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3933 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3934 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3935
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003936 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3937 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3938 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3939 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3940 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3941 another equipment.
3942
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003943 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3944 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3945 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3946 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3947 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3948 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3949 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3950 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3951
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003952 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3953 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3954 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3955 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3956 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3957 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3958 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3959 admin privileges.
3960
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003961 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3962 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3963 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3964 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3965 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3966 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3967 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3968 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3969
3970 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3971 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3972 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3973 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3974 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3975 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3976
3977 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3978 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3979 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3980 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3981 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3982 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3983
3984 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3985 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3986 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3987 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3988 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3989 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3990 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3991 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3992 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3993
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003994 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003995 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3996 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3997 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3998 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3999 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
4000 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
4001 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
4002 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4003 request header" for more information.
4004
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004005 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
4006 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
4007 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
4008 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004009 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4010 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004011
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004012 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4013 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
4014 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
4015 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
4016 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
4017 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
4018 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
4019 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
4020 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
4021 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
4022 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
4023 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4024
4025 These actions take one or two arguments :
4026 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
4027 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
4028 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
4029 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
4030
4031 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
4032 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
4033 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
4034 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
4035
4036 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
4037 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
4038 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
4039 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
4040 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
4041 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
4042 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
4043 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
4044
4045 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
4046 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
4047 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
4048 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
4049 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
4050
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004051 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4052 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4053 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4054 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4055 continues.
4056
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004057 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4058 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4059 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4060 the actions evaluation continues.
4061
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004062 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
4063 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4064 inline.
4065
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004066 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4067 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004068 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004069 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4070 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004071 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004072 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004073 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004074 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4075 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004076 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004077 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004078 and '_'.
4079
4080 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4081 followed by some converters.
4082
4083 Example:
4084
4085 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4086
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004087 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4088 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4089
4090 Example:
4091
4092 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4093
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004094 - set-src <expr> :
4095 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4096 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4097 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4098 source IP for privacy.
4099
4100 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4101 followed by some converters.
4102
4103 Example:
4104
4105 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4106 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4107
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004108 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4109 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004110
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004111 - set-src-port <expr> :
4112 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4113 expression.
4114
4115 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4116 followed by some converters.
4117
4118 Example:
4119
4120 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4121 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4122
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004123 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4124 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4125 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004126
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004127 - set-dst <expr> :
4128 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4129 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4130 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4131 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4132 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4133
4134 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4135 followed by some converters.
4136
4137 Example:
4138
4139 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4140 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4141
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004142 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4143 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4144
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004145 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4146 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4147 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4148 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4149
4150 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4151 followed by some converters.
4152
4153 Example:
4154
4155 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4156 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4157
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004158 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4159 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4160 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4161
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004162 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4163 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4164 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4165 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4166 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4167 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4168 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4169 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4170 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4171 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4172 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4173 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4174 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4175 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4176 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4177 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4178
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004179
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004180 - "wait-for-handshake" : this will delay the processing of the request
4181 until the SSL handshake happened. This is mostly useful to delay
4182 processing early data until we're sure they are valid.
4183
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004184 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4185 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4186 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4187 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4188 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4189 SPOE agent name must be used.
4190
4191 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4192
4193 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4194 configuration.
4195
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004196 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4197
4198 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4199 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004200 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4201 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4202
4203 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4204 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4205 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4206 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004207
4208 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004209 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4210 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4211 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004212
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004213 http-request allow if nagios
4214 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4215 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4216 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004217
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004218 Example:
4219 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004220 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004221
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004222 Example:
4223 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4224 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004225 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004226 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4227 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4228 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4229 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4230 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4231 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4232
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004233 Example:
4234 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4235 acl add path /addacl
4236 acl del path /delacl
4237
4238 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4239
4240 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4241 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4242
4243 Example:
4244 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4245 acl setmap path /setmap
4246 acl delmap path /delmap
4247
4248 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4249
4250 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4251 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4252
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004253 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4254 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004255
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004256http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004257 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004258 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004259 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4260 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004261 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004262 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4263 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4264 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4265 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004266 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004267 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004268 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004269 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004270 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004271 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004272 silent-drop |
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004273 send-spoe-group
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004274 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004275 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004276 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4277
4278 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4279 no | yes | yes | yes
4280
4281 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4282 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4283 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4284 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4285 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4286 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4287
4288 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4289 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4290 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4291 current section.
4292
4293 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4294 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4295 rules are evaluated.
4296
4297 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4298 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4299 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4300 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4301 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4302 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4303 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4304
4305 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4306 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4307 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4308 external users.
4309
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004310 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4311 <name>.
4312
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004313 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4314 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4315 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4316 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4317 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4318 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4319 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4320 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4321
4322 Example:
4323
4324 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4325
4326 applied to:
4327
4328 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4329
4330 outputs:
4331
4332 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4333
4334 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4335
4336 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4337 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4338 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4339 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4340 header.
4341
4342 Example:
4343
4344 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4345
4346 applied to:
4347
4348 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4349
4350 outputs:
4351
4352 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4353
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004354 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004355 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4356 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4357 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004358
4359 Example:
4360
4361 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4362 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004363 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4364 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004365
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004366 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4367 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4368 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4369 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4370 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4371 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4372 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4373 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4374
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004375 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4376 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4377 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4378 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4379 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4380 another equipment.
4381
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004382 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4383 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4384 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4385 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4386 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4387 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4388 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4389 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4390
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004391 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4392 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4393 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4394 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4395 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4396 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4397 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4398 admin privileges.
4399
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004400 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4401 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4402 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4403 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4404 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4405 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4406 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4407 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4408
4409 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4410 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4411 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4412 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4413 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4414 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4415
4416 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4417 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4418 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4419 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4420 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4421 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4422
4423 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4424 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4425 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4426 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4427 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4428 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4429 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4430 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4431 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4432
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004433 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4434 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4435 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4436 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4437 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4438 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4439 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4440 response header" for more information.
4441
4442 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4443 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4444 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4445 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4446 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004447 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4448 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004449
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004450 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4451 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4452 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4453 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4454 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4455 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4456
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004457 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4458 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4459 inline.
4460
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004461 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4462 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004463 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004464 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4465 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004466 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004467 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004468 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004469 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4470 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004471 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004472 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4473 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004474
4475 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4476 followed by some converters.
4477
4478 Example:
4479
4480 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4481
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004482 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4483 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4484
4485 Example:
4486
4487 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4488
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004489 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4490 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4491 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4492 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4493 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4494 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4495 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4496
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004497 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4498 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4499 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4500 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4501 continues.
4502
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004503 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4504 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4505 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4506 the actions evaluation continues.
4507
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004508 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4509 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4510 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4511 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4512 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4513 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4514 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4515 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4516 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4517 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4518 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4519 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4520 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4521 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4522 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4523 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4524
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004525 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4526 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4527 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4528 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4529 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4530 SPOE agent name must be used.
4531
4532 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4533
4534 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4535 configuration.
4536
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004537 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4538
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004539 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004540 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4541 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004542 rules.
4543
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004544 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4545 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4546 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4547 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4548
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004549 Example:
4550 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4551
4552 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4553
4554 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4555 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4556
4557 Example:
4558 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4559
4560 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4561
4562 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4563 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4564
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004565 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4566 ACL usage.
4567
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004568
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004569http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4570 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4571
4572 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4573 yes | no | yes | yes
4574
4575 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4576 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4577 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4578 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4579 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4580 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4581
4582 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4583
4584 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4585 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4586 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4587 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4588 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4589 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4590 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4591 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4592 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4593 not checking any request past the first one.
4594
4595 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4596 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4597 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4598 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4599 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4600 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4601 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4602
4603 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4604 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4605 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4606 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4607 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4608 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4609 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4610 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4611 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4612 downsides of rare connection failures.
4613
4614 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4615 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4616 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4617 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4618 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4619 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4620 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4621 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4622 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4623 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4624 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4625 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4626
4627 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4628 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4629 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4630 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4631
4632 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4633 and are never shared ;
4634
4635 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4636 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4637 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4638 and are never shared ;
4639
4640 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4641 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4642 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4643
4644 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4645 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4646 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4647
4648 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4649
4650
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004651http-send-name-header [<header>]
4652 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4653
4654 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4655 yes | no | yes | yes
4656
4657 Arguments :
4658
4659 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4660
4661 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4662 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4663 is added with the header string proved.
4664
4665 See also : "server"
4666
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004667id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004668 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4670 no | yes | yes | yes
4671 Arguments : none
4672
4673 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4674 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4675 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004676
4677
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004678ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4679 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4680 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4681 no | yes | yes | yes
4682
4683 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4684 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4685 and running).
4686
4687 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4688 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4689 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004690 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004691 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4692
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004693 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4694 "unless" condition is met.
4695
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004696 Example:
4697 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
4698 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
4699 ignore-persist if url_static
4700
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004701 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4702
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004703load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4704 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4705 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4706 yes | no | yes | yes
4707
4708 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4709 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4710 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4711 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4712 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4713 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4714 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4715 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4716
4717 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4718 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02004719 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004720
4721 Arguments:
4722 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4723 named "server-state-file".
4724
4725 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4726 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4727 name is used as a file name.
4728
4729 none don't load any stat for this backend
4730
4731 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004732 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4733 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4734 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4735 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4736 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004737
4738 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4739 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4740
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004741 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004742
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004743 global
4744 stats socket /tmp/socket
4745 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004746
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004747 defaults
4748 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004749
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004750 backend bk
4751 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4752 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004753
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004754
4755 Then one can run :
4756
4757 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4758
4759 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4760
4761 1
4762 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4763 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4764 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4765
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004766 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004767
4768 global
4769 stats socket /tmp/socket
4770 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4771
4772 defaults
4773 load-server-state-from-file local
4774
4775 backend bk
4776 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4777 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4778
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004779
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004780 Then one can run :
4781
4782 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4783
4784 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4785
4786 1
4787 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4788 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4789 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4790
4791 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4792 "show servers state"
4793
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004794
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004795log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004796log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004797no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004798 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4800 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004801
4802 Prefix :
4803 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4804 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4805 prefix does not allow arguments.
4806
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004807 Arguments :
4808 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4809 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4810 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4811 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4812 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4813 parameter.
4814
4815 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4816 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4817
4818 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4819 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4820 standard syslog port).
4821
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004822 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4823 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4824 standard syslog port).
4825
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004826 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4827 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4828 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4829 appropriately writeable).
4830
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004831 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4832 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004833
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004834 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4835 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4836 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4837 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4838 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4839 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4840 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4841 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4842 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4843 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4844 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4845
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004846 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4847
4848 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4849 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4850 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4851
4852 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4853 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4854 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004855 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4856 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4857 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4858 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4859 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004860
4861 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4862
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004863 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4864 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4865 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004866
4867 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4868 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4869 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4870 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4871
4872 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4873 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004874
4875 Example :
4876 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004877 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4878 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004879 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004880
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004881
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004882log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004883 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4884 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4885 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004886
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004887 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4888 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4889 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4890 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4891 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004892
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02004893 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
4894 "option httplog" directives.
4895
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004896log-format-sd <string>
4897 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4898 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4899 yes | yes | yes | no
4900
4901 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4902 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4903 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4904 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4905 which covers the log format string in depth.
4906
4907 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4908 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4909
4910 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4911 log format to "rfc5424".
4912
4913 Example :
4914 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4915
4916
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004917log-tag <string>
4918 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4919 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4920 yes | yes | yes | yes
4921
4922 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4923 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4924 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4925 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4926 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4927 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4928 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4929 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4930 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004931
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004932max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4933 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4934 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4935 yes | no | yes | yes
4936
4937 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4938 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4939 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4940 servers.
4941
4942 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4943 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4944 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4945 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4946 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4947 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4948 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4949 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4950 picking a different server.
4951
4952 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4953 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4954 even if they have to be queued.
4955
4956 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4957 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4958
4959
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004960maxconn <conns>
4961 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4963 yes | yes | yes | no
4964 Arguments :
4965 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4966 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4967 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4968 closes.
4969
4970 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4971 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4972 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4973 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004974 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4975 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4976 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4977 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004978
4979 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4980 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4981 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4982
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004983 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4984
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004985 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4986
4987
4988mode { tcp|http|health }
4989 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4991 yes | yes | yes | yes
4992 Arguments :
4993 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4994 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4995 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4996 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4997
4998 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4999 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5000 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5001 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5002 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5003
5004 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005005 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5006 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5007 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5008 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5009 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5010 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5011 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005012
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005013 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5014 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5015 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005016
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005017 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005018 defaults http_instances
5019 mode http
5020
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005021 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005022
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005023
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005024monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005025 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5027 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005028 Arguments :
5029 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5030 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005031 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005032 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5033 backend and its backup.
5034
5035 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5036 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5037 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5038 servers in a list of backends.
5039
5040 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5041 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5042 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5043 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5044 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5045 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5046 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005047 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5048 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005049
5050 Example:
5051 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005052 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005053 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5054 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5055 monitor-uri /site_alive
5056 monitor fail if site_dead
5057
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005058 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005059
5060
5061monitor-net <source>
5062 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5064 yes | yes | yes | no
5065 Arguments :
5066 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5067 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5068 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5069 followed by a mask.
5070
5071 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5072 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005073 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005074 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5075
5076 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5077 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5078 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5079 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005080 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5081 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5082 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005083
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005084 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5085 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5086 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5087 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5088 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5089 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005090
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005091 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5092 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005093
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005094 Example :
5095 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5096 frontend www
5097 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5098
5099 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5100
5101
5102monitor-uri <uri>
5103 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5105 yes | yes | yes | no
5106 Arguments :
5107 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5108 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5109
5110 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5111 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5112 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5113 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5114 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5115 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5116 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5117 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5118
5119 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
5120 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5121 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5122 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5123 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5124 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
5125
5126 Example :
5127 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5128 frontend www
5129 mode http
5130 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5131
5132 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5133
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005134
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005135option abortonclose
5136no option abortonclose
5137 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5139 yes | no | yes | yes
5140 Arguments : none
5141
5142 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5143 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5144 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5145 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005146 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005147 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5148 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5149 encountered while delivering the response.
5150
5151 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5152 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5153 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5154 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5155 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5156 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005157 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005158 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005159 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005160 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5161 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5162 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5163
5164 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5165 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5166 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5167 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5168 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5169 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5170 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5171 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005172 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005173
5174 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5175 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5176
5177 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5178
5179
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005180option accept-invalid-http-request
5181no option accept-invalid-http-request
5182 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5184 yes | yes | yes | no
5185 Arguments : none
5186
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005187 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005188 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5189 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5190 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5191 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5192 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5193 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5194 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005195 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5196 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5197 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5198 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5199 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005200 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005201 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5202 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5203 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005204
5205 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5206 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5207 been confirmed.
5208
5209 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5210 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005211 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5212 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005213 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5214
5215 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5216 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5217
5218 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5219 stats socket.
5220
5221
5222option accept-invalid-http-response
5223no option accept-invalid-http-response
5224 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5226 yes | no | yes | yes
5227 Arguments : none
5228
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005229 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005230 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5231 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5232 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5233 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5234 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5235 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5236 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005237 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5238 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5239 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005240
5241 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5242 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5243 been confirmed.
5244
5245 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5246 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5247 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5248 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5249
5250 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5251 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5252
5253 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5254 stats socket.
5255
5256
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005257option allbackups
5258no option allbackups
5259 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5261 yes | no | yes | yes
5262 Arguments : none
5263
5264 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5265 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5266 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5267 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5268 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5269 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5270 order between the backup servers anymore.
5271
5272 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5273 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5274
5275 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5276 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5277
5278
5279option checkcache
5280no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005281 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5283 yes | no | yes | yes
5284 Arguments : none
5285
5286 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5287 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005288 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005289 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5290 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005291 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005292
5293 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005294 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005295 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005296 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5297 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005298 to the client are :
5299 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005300 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005301 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005302 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5303 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5304 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5305 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5306 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5307 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5308 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5309 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5310 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5311 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5312 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5313
5314 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005315 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005316 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005317 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005318 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5319
5320 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5321 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005322 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005323 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5324
5325 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5326 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5327
5328
5329option clitcpka
5330no option clitcpka
5331 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5333 yes | yes | yes | no
5334 Arguments : none
5335
5336 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5337 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5338 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5339 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5340
5341 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5342 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5343 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5344 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5345
5346 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5347 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5348 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5349 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5350 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5351
5352 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5353
5354 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5355 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5356 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5357
5358 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5359 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5360
5361 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5362
5363
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005364option contstats
5365 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5367 yes | yes | yes | no
5368 Arguments : none
5369
5370 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5371 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5372 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5373 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005374 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5375 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5376 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5377 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5378 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005379
5380
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005381option dontlog-normal
5382no option dontlog-normal
5383 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5385 yes | yes | yes | no
5386 Arguments : none
5387
5388 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5389 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5390 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5391 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5392 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5393 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5394 logged.
5395
5396 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5397 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5398 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5399
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005400 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005401 logging.
5402
5403
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005404option dontlognull
5405no option dontlognull
5406 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5408 yes | yes | yes | no
5409 Arguments : none
5410
5411 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5412 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5413 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5414 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5415 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5416 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005417 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5418 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5419 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005420
5421 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5422 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5423 would not be logged.
5424
5425 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5426 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5427
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005428 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5429 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005430
5431
5432option forceclose
5433no option forceclose
5434 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005436 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005437 Arguments : none
5438
5439 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5440 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5441 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5442 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5443 global session times in the logs.
5444
5445 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005446 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005447 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005448
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005449 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5450 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5451 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5452
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005453 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5454 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005455
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005456 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5457 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5458
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005459 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005460
5461
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005462option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005463 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5465 yes | yes | yes | yes
5466 Arguments :
5467 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5468 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005469 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005470 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005471
5472 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5473 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5474 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5475 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5476 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5477 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5478 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005479 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5480 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5481 possible that the client has already brought one.
5482
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005483 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005484 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005485 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5486 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005487 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5488 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005489
5490 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5491 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5492 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5493 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5494 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5495 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5496 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5497
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005498 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5499 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5500 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5501 are under the control of the end-user.
5502
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005503 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005504 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5505 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005506 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5507 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5508 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005509
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005510 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005511 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5512 frontend www
5513 mode http
5514 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5515
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005516 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5517 backend www
5518 mode http
5519 option forwardfor header X-Client
5520
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005521 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005522 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005523
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005524
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005525option http-buffer-request
5526no option http-buffer-request
5527 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5529 yes | yes | yes | yes
5530 Arguments : none
5531
5532 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5533 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5534 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5535 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5536 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5537 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5538 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5539 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005540 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005541 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5542 default.
5543
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005544 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005545
5546
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005547option http-ignore-probes
5548no option http-ignore-probes
5549 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5551 yes | yes | yes | no
5552 Arguments : none
5553
5554 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5555 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5556 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5557 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5558 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5559 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5560 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5561 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5562 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5563 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5564 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5565 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5566
5567 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5568 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5569 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5570 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5571 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5572 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5573 are often the only way to detect them.
5574
5575 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5576 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5577
5578 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5579
5580
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005581option http-keep-alive
5582no option http-keep-alive
5583 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5585 yes | yes | yes | yes
5586 Arguments : none
5587
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005588 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5589 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5590 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5591 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5592 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5593 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5594 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5595
5596 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5597 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005598 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5599 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5600 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5601 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5602 situations where this option may be useful :
5603
5604 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5605 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5606
5607 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5608 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5609
5610 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5611 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5612 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5613 request.
5614
5615 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5616 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005617 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5618 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5619 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005620
5621 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5622 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5623
5624 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5625 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5626 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5627 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5628 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5629 not set.
5630
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005631 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5632 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005633 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005634 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005635
5636 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005637 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5638 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005639
5640
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005641option http-no-delay
5642no option http-no-delay
5643 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5645 yes | yes | yes | yes
5646 Arguments : none
5647
5648 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5649 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5650 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5651 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5652 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5653 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5654 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5655 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5656 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5657 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5658 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5659 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5660 affected.
5661
5662 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5663 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5664 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5665 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5666 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5667 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5668 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5669 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5670 latency environments.
5671
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005672 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5673
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005674
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005675option http-pretend-keepalive
5676no option http-pretend-keepalive
5677 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5679 yes | yes | yes | yes
5680 Arguments : none
5681
5682 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5683 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5684 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5685 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5686 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5687 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5688 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5689 consider the response complete.
5690
5691 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5692 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5693 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5694 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5695 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5696 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5697
5698 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5699 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5700 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5701 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5702 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5703 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5704 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5705
5706 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5707 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005708 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005709 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5710 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005711
5712 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5713 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5714
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005715 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5716 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005717
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005718
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005719option http-server-close
5720no option http-server-close
5721 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5723 yes | yes | yes | yes
5724 Arguments : none
5725
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005726 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5727 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5728 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5729 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5730 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5731 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5732 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5733 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5734 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5735 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5736 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005737 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005738 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5739 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5740 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5741 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005742
5743 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5744 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5745 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5746 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005747 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5748 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005749
5750 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5751 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005752 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5753 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005754 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5755 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005756
5757 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5758 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5759
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005760 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005761 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5762 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005763
5764
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005765option http-tunnel
5766no option http-tunnel
5767 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5769 yes | yes | yes | yes
5770 Arguments : none
5771
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005772 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5773 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5774 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5775 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5776 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5777 "option http-tunnel".
5778
5779 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005780 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005781 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5782 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5783 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5784 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5785 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5786 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5787 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005788
5789 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5790 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5791
5792 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5793 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5794 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5795
5796
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005797option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005798no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005799 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5801 yes | yes | yes | no
5802 Arguments : none
5803
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005804 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005805 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5806 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5807 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5808 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5809 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5810 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5811
5812 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5813 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005814 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5815 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5816 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005817
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005818 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5819 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5820 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5821 front of an existing proxy.
5822
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005823 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5824
5825 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5826 http-server-close".
5827
5828
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005829option httpchk
5830option httpchk <uri>
5831option httpchk <method> <uri>
5832option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5833 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5835 yes | no | yes | yes
5836 Arguments :
5837 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5838 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5839 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5840 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5841 ones.
5842
5843 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5844 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5845 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5846
5847 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5848 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5849 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5850 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5851 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5852
5853 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5854 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5855 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5856 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5857 the lack of any response.
5858
5859 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5860
5861 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5862 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5863 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5864
5865 Examples :
5866 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5867 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5868 backend https_relay
5869 mode tcp
5870 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5871 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5872
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005873 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5874 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5875 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005876
5877
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005878option httpclose
5879no option httpclose
5880 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5882 yes | yes | yes | yes
5883 Arguments : none
5884
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005885 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5886 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5887 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5888 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005889 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005890 "option http-tunnel".
5891
5892 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5893 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5894 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5895 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5896 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5897 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5898 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5899 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005900
5901 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005902 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005903 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5904 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5905 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5906 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5907 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005908
5909 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5910 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005911 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5912 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005913 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5914 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005915
5916 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5917 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5918
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005919 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5920 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005921
5922
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005923option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005924 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5926 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005927 Arguments :
5928 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5929 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5930 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5931 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5932 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005933
5934 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5935 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5936 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5937 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5938 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5939 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5940 ports.
5941
5942 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5943
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005944 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5945 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005946
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005947 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
5948
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005949 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005950
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005951
5952option http_proxy
5953no option http_proxy
5954 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5956 yes | yes | yes | yes
5957 Arguments : none
5958
5959 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5960 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5961 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5962 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5963 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5964
5965 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5966 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005967 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5968 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005969
5970 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5971 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5972
5973 Example :
5974 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5975 backend direct_forward
5976 option httpclose
5977 option http_proxy
5978
5979 See also : "option httpclose"
5980
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005981
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005982option independent-streams
5983no option independent-streams
5984 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5986 yes | yes | yes | yes
5987 Arguments : none
5988
5989 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5990 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5991 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5992 receive data or not.
5993
5994 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5995 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5996 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5997 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5998 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5999 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6000 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6001 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6002 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6003 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6004 socket buffers.
6005
6006 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6007 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6008 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6009 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6010 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6011
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006012 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006013 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6014 deprecated.
6015
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006016 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006017
6018
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006019option ldap-check
6020 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6022 yes | no | yes | yes
6023 Arguments : none
6024
6025 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6026 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6027 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6028 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6029
6030 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6031 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6032
6033 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6034 configure it.
6035
6036 Example :
6037 option ldap-check
6038
6039 See also : "option httpchk"
6040
6041
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006042option external-check
6043 Use external processes for server health checks
6044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6045 yes | no | yes | yes
6046
6047 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6048 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6049 command".
6050
6051 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6052
6053 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6054
6055
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006056option log-health-checks
6057no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006058 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6060 yes | no | yes | yes
6061 Arguments : none
6062
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006063 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6064 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6065 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006066
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006067 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6068 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6069 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6070 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6071 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6072
6073 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
6074 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006075
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006076 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6077 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6078 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006079
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006080
6081option log-separate-errors
6082no option log-separate-errors
6083 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6085 yes | yes | yes | no
6086 Arguments : none
6087
6088 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6089 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6090 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6091 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6092 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6093 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6094 provides very important information.
6095
6096 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6097 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6098 error logs.
6099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006100 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006101 logging.
6102
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006103
6104option logasap
6105no option logasap
6106 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6108 yes | yes | yes | no
6109 Arguments : none
6110
6111 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6112 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6113 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6114 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6115 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6116 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6117 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006118 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006119 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6120 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6121
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006122 Examples :
6123 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6124 mode http
6125 option httplog
6126 option logasap
6127 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6128
6129 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6130 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6131 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6132 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6133
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006134 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006135 logging.
6136
6137
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006138option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006139 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6141 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006142 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006143 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6144 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006145 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006146
6147 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6148 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
6149 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
6150 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6151 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6152 in the MySQL table, like this :
6153
6154 USE mysql;
6155 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6156 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6157
6158 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6159 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6160 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6161 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6162 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6163 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6164 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6165 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6166 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6167
6168 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6169 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006170
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006171 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006172
6173 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6174 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6175 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6176 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006177 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6178 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006179
6180 See also: "option httpchk"
6181
6182
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006183option nolinger
6184no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006185 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006186 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6187 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006188 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006189
6190 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6191 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6192 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6193 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6194 connections.
6195
6196 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6197 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6198 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6199 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6200 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6201 this too.
6202
6203 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6204 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6205 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6206
6207 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6208 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6209 for servers.
6210
6211 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6212 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6213
6214
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006215option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6216 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6218 yes | yes | yes | yes
6219 Arguments :
6220 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6221 matching <network>
6222 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6223 header name.
6224
6225 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6226 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6227 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6228 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6229 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6230 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6231 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6232 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6233 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6234 possible that the client has already brought one.
6235
6236 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6237 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6238 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6239 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6240 header and requires different one.
6241
6242 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6243 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6244 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6245 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6246 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6247 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6248 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6249
6250 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6251 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6252 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6253 both are defined.
6254
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006255 Examples :
6256 # Original Destination address
6257 frontend www
6258 mode http
6259 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6260
6261 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6262 backend www
6263 mode http
6264 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6265
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006266 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6267 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006268
6269
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006270option persist
6271no option persist
6272 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6273 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6274 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006275 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006276
6277 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6278 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6279 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6280 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6281 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6282 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6283 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6284 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6285 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6286 redirected to another valid server.
6287
6288 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6289 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6290
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006291 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006292
6293
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006294option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6295 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6297 yes | no | yes | yes
6298 Arguments :
6299 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6300 PostgreSQL server.
6301
6302 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6303 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6304 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6305 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6306
6307 See also: "option httpchk"
6308
6309
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006310option prefer-last-server
6311no option prefer-last-server
6312 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6313 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6314 yes | no | yes | yes
6315 Arguments : none
6316
6317 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6318 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6319 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6320 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6321 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6322 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6323 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6324 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6325 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006326 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6327 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6328 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6329 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6330 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6331 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6332 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006333
6334 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6335 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6336
6337 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6338
6339
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006340option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006341option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006342no option redispatch
6343 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6344 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6345 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006346 Arguments :
6347 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6348 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6349 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6350 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6351 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6352 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6353 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6354 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6355 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6356
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006357
6358 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6359 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6360 be able to access the service anymore.
6361
6362 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6363 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6364
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006365 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006366 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6367 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006368
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006369 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6370 "redisp" keywords.
6371
6372 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6373 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6374
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006375 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006376
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006377
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006378option redis-check
6379 Use redis health checks for server testing
6380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6381 yes | no | yes | yes
6382 Arguments : none
6383
6384 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6385 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6386 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6387 find the "+PONG" response message.
6388
6389 Example :
6390 option redis-check
6391
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006392 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006393
6394
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006395option smtpchk
6396option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6397 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6399 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006400 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006401 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6402 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6403 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6404
6405 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6406 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6407 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6408
6409 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6410 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6411 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6412 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6413 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6414 dead server.
6415
6416 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6417 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6418 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6419 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6420
6421 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6422 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6423 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6424 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006425 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006426
6427 Example :
6428 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6429
6430 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6431
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006432
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006433option socket-stats
6434no option socket-stats
6435
6436 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6438 yes | yes | yes | no
6439
6440 Arguments : none
6441
6442
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006443option splice-auto
6444no option splice-auto
6445 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6447 yes | yes | yes | yes
6448 Arguments : none
6449
6450 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6451 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6452 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6453 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006454 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006455 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6456 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6457 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6458 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6459
6460 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6461 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6462 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6463 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6464 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6465 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6466 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6467 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6468 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6469 keyword.
6470
6471 Example :
6472 option splice-auto
6473
6474 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6475 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6476
6477 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6478 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6479
6480
6481option splice-request
6482no option splice-request
6483 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6485 yes | yes | yes | yes
6486 Arguments : none
6487
6488 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006489 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006490 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6491 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6492 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6493 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6494
6495 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6496
6497 Example :
6498 option splice-request
6499
6500 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6501 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6502
6503 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6504 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6505
6506
6507option splice-response
6508no option splice-response
6509 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6511 yes | yes | yes | yes
6512 Arguments : none
6513
6514 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006515 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006516 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6517 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6518 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6519 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6520
6521 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6522
6523 Example :
6524 option splice-response
6525
6526 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6527 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6528
6529 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6530 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6531
6532
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006533option spop-check
6534 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6536 no | no | no | yes
6537 Arguments : none
6538
6539 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6540 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6541 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6542 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6543
6544 Example :
6545 option spop-check
6546
6547 See also : "option httpchk"
6548
6549
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006550option srvtcpka
6551no option srvtcpka
6552 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6554 yes | no | yes | yes
6555 Arguments : none
6556
6557 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6558 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6559 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6560 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6561
6562 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6563 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6564 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6565 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6566
6567 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6568 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6569 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6570 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6571 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6572
6573 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6574
6575 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6576 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6577 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6578
6579 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6580 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6581
6582 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6583
6584
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006585option ssl-hello-chk
6586 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6588 yes | no | yes | yes
6589 Arguments : none
6590
6591 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6592 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6593 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6594 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6595 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6596 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6597 hello message.
6598
6599 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6600 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6601 messages, which is appreciable.
6602
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006603 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6604 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6605 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006606
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006607 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6608
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006609
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006610option tcp-check
6611 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6612 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6613 yes | no | yes | yes
6614
6615 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6616 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6617
6618 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6619 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6620 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6621
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006622 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006623 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6624 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6625 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6626 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6627 only.
6628
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006629 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006630 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6631 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6632 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6633 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6634
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006635 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006636 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6637 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006638 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006639 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6640 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6641 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6642 the respective protocols.
6643 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6644 analysed.
6645
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006646 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6647 script.
6648
6649 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6650 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6651 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6652 The "comment" is of course optional.
6653
6654
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006655 Examples :
6656 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6657 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006658 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006659
6660 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6661 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006662 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006663
6664 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6665 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006666 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006667 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006668 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006669 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006670 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006671 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006672 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6673 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006674 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006675 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6676 tcp-check expect string +OK
6677
6678 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6679 (send many headers before analyzing)
6680 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006681 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006682 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6683 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6684 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6685 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006686 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006687
6688
6689 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6690
6691
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006692option tcp-smart-accept
6693no option tcp-smart-accept
6694 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6696 yes | yes | yes | no
6697 Arguments : none
6698
6699 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6700 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6701 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6702 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6703 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6704 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6705
6706 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6707 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6708 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6709 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6710
6711 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6712 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6713 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6714 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6715
6716 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6717 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6718 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6719
6720 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6721 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6722 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6723
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006724 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6725
6726
6727option tcp-smart-connect
6728no option tcp-smart-connect
6729 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6731 yes | no | yes | yes
6732 Arguments : none
6733
6734 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6735 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6736 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6737 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6738 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6739
6740 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6741 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6742 complex.
6743
6744 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6745 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6746 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6747
6748 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6749 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6750
6751 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6752
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006753
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006754option tcpka
6755 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6757 yes | yes | yes | yes
6758 Arguments : none
6759
6760 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6761 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6762 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6763 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6764
6765 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6766 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6767 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6768 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6769
6770 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6771 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6772 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6773 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6774 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6775
6776 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6777
6778 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6779 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6780 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6781 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6782 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6783 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6784 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6785 backends.
6786
6787 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6788
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006789
6790option tcplog
6791 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6793 yes | yes | yes | yes
6794 Arguments : none
6795
6796 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6797 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6798 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6799 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6800 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6801 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6802 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6803 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6804
6805 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6806
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006807 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6808
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006809 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006810
6811
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006812option transparent
6813no option transparent
6814 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006816 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006817 Arguments : none
6818
6819 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6820 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6821 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6822 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6823 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6824 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6825 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6826 appropriate server.
6827
6828 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6829 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6830
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006831 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006832 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006833
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006834
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006835external-check command <command>
6836 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6838 yes | no | yes | yes
6839
6840 Arguments :
6841 <command> is the external command to run
6842
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006843 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6844
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006845 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006846
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006847 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6848 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6849 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6850 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6851 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6852 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006853
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006854 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6855
6856 Environment variables :
6857 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6858 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6859
6860 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6861
6862 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6863
6864 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6865 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6866 for a UNIX socket).
6867
6868 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6869
6870 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6871
6872 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6873
6874 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6875
6876 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6877
6878 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6879 socket).
6880
6881 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6882 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6883
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006884 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6885 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6886 failed.
6887
6888 Example :
6889 external-check command /bin/true
6890
6891 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6892
6893
6894external-check path <path>
6895 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6897 yes | no | yes | yes
6898
6899 Arguments :
6900 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6901
6902 The default path is "".
6903
6904 Example :
6905 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6906
6907 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6908 "external-check command"
6909
6910
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006911persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006912persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006913 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6915 yes | no | yes | yes
6916 Arguments :
6917 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006918 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6919 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006920
6921 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6922 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6923 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6924 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6925 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6926 forwarded to this server.
6927
6928 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6929 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6930 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006931 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006932 a single "listen" section.
6933
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006934 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6935 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6936 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6937
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006938 Example :
6939 listen tse-farm
6940 bind :3389
6941 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6942 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6943 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6944 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6945 persist rdp-cookie
6946 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006947 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006948 balance rdp-cookie
6949 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6950 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6951
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006952 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6953 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006954
6955
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006956rate-limit sessions <rate>
6957 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6959 yes | yes | yes | no
6960 Arguments :
6961 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6962 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6963
6964 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6965 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6966 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6967 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6968 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6969 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6970
6971 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6972 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6973 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6974 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6975
6976 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6977 listen smtp
6978 mode tcp
6979 bind :25
6980 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006981 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006982
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006983 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6984 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6985 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006986
6987 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6988
6989
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006990redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6991redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6992redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006993 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6995 no | yes | yes | yes
6996
6997 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006998 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006999
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007000 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007001 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007002 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7003 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7004 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007005
7006 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7007 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7008 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7009 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7010 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007011 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7012 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7013 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7014 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007015
7016 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7017 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7018 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7019 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7020 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7021 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007022 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007023 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007024 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7025 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7026 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007027
7028 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007029 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7030 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7031 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007032 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007033 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7034 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7035 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7036 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007037
7038 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
7039 expected behaviour of a redirection :
7040
7041 - "drop-query"
7042 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7043 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7044 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7045 with a location-type redirect.
7046
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007047 - "append-slash"
7048 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7049 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7050 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7051 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7052
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007053 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7054 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7055 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7056 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7057 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7058 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7059 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7060
7061 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7062 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7063 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7064 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7065 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7066 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7067 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007068
7069 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7070 acl clear dst_port 80
7071 acl secure dst_port 8080
7072 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007073 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007074 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007075 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7076
7077 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007078 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7079 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7080 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007081 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007082
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007083 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7084 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7085 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7086
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007087 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007088 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007089
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007090 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007091 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7092 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7093 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007094
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007095 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007096
7097
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007098redisp (deprecated)
7099redispatch (deprecated)
7100 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7101 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7102 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007103 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007104
7105 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7106 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7107 be able to access the service anymore.
7108
7109 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7110 redistribute them to a working server.
7111
7112 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7113 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7114 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007115
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007116 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7117 "option redispatch" instead.
7118
7119 See also : "option redispatch"
7120
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007121
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007122reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007123 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7125 no | yes | yes | yes
7126 Arguments :
7127 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7128 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007129 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007130
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007131 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7132 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7133
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007134 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7135 the last header of an HTTP request.
7136
7137 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7138 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7139 responses.
7140
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007141 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7142 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7143 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7144
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007145 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7146 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007147
7148
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007149reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7150reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007151 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7153 no | yes | yes | yes
7154 Arguments :
7155 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7156 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7157 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7158 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7159 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7160 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7161 ignores case.
7162
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007163 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7164 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7165
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007166 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7167 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7168 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7169 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007170 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007171
7172 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7173 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7174
7175 Example :
7176 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7177 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7178 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7179
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007180 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7181 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007182
7183
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007184reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7185reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007186 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7188 no | yes | yes | yes
7189 Arguments :
7190 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7191 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7192 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7193 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7194 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7195 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7196
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007197 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7198 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7199
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007200 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7201 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7202 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7203 next servers.
7204
7205 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7206 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7207 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7208
7209 Example :
7210 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7211 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7212 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7213
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007214 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7215 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007216
7217
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007218reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7219reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007220 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7222 no | yes | yes | yes
7223 Arguments :
7224 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7225 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7226 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7227 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7228 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7229 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7230 case.
7231
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007232 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7233 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7234
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007235 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7236 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7237 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7238 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007239 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007240
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007241 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007242 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007243 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007244
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007245 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7246 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7247
7248 Example :
7249 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7250 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7251 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7252
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007253 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7254 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007255
7256
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007257reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7258reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007259 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7261 no | yes | yes | yes
7262 Arguments :
7263 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7264 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7265 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7266 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7267 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7268 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7269 case.
7270
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007271 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7272 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7273
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007274 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7275 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7276 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7277 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7278
7279 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7280 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7281
7282 Example :
7283 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7284 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7285 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7286 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7287
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007288 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7289 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007290
7291
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007292reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7293reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007294 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7296 no | yes | yes | yes
7297 Arguments :
7298 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7299 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7300 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7301 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7302 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7303 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7304
7305 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7306 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7307 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7308 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007309 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007310
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007311 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7312 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7313
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007314 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7315 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7316 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7317
7318 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7319 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7320 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7321 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7322 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7323
7324 Example :
7325 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007326 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007327 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7328 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7329
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007330 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7331 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007332
7333
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007334reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7335reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007336 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7338 no | yes | yes | yes
7339 Arguments :
7340 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7341 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7342 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7343 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7344 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7345 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7346 ignores case.
7347
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007348 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7349 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7350
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007351 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7352 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007353 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7354 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7355 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007356 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7357 not set.
7358
7359 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7360 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7361 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7362 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7363 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7364
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007365 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007366 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7367 # block all others.
7368 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7369 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7370
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007371 # block bad guys
7372 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7373 reqitarpit . if badguys
7374
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007375 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7376 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007377
7378
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007379retries <value>
7380 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7381 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7382 yes | no | yes | yes
7383 Arguments :
7384 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7385 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7386 default value is 3.
7387
7388 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7389 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7390 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7391
7392 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007393 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7394 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007395
7396 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7397 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7398
7399 See also : "option redispatch"
7400
7401
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007402rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007403 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7405 no | yes | yes | yes
7406 Arguments :
7407 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7408 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007409 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007410
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007411 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7412 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7413
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007414 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7415 the last header of an HTTP response.
7416
7417 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7418 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7419 responses.
7420
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007421 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7422 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007423
7424
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007425rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7426rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007427 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7429 no | yes | yes | yes
7430 Arguments :
7431 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7432 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7433 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7434 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7435 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7436 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7437 ignores case.
7438
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007439 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7440 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7441
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007442 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7443 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007444 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007445 client.
7446
7447 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7448 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7449 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7450
7451 Example :
7452 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007453 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007454
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007455 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7456 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007457
7458
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007459rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7460rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007461 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7463 no | yes | yes | yes
7464 Arguments :
7465 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7466 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7467 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7468 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7469 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7470 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7471 ignores case.
7472
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007473 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7474 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7475
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007476 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7477 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7478 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7479 case-sensitive.
7480
7481 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007482 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7483 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7484 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007485
7486 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7487 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7488
7489 Example :
7490 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7491 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7492
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007493 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7494 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007495
7496
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007497rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7498rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007499 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7501 no | yes | yes | yes
7502 Arguments :
7503 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7504 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7505 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7506 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7507 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7508 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7509 ignores case.
7510
7511 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7512 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7513 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7514 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007515 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007516
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007517 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7518 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7519
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007520 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7521 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7522 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7523
7524 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7525 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7526 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7527 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7528 are not case-sensitive.
7529
7530 Example :
7531 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7532 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7533
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007534 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7535 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007536
7537
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007538server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007539 Declare a server in a backend
7540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7541 no | no | yes | yes
7542 Arguments :
7543 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007544 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007545 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007546
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007547 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7548 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7549 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7550 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007551 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7552 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7553 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7554 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7555 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007556 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7557 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7558 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7559 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7560 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7561 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7562 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007563 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007564 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7565 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007566 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7567 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007568
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007569 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007570 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7571 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7572 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7573 adding this value to the client's port.
7574
7575 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7576 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007577 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007578
7579 Examples :
7580 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7581 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007582 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007583 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7584 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7585 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007586
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007587 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7588 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7589 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7590 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7591 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7592
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007593 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7594 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007595
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007596server-state-file-name [<file>]
7597 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7598 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7599 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7600 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7601 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7602 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7603
7604 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7605 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7606
7607 global
7608 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7609
7610 backend bk
7611 load-server-state-from-file
7612
7613 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7614 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007615
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007616server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7617 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7618 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7620 no | no | yes | yes
7621
7622 Arguments:
7623 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7624
7625 <num | range>
7626 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7627 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7628 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7629 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7630
7631 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7632
7633 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7634
7635 <params*>
7636 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7637 keyword.
7638
7639 Examples:
7640 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7641 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7642 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7643
7644 # or
7645 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7646
7647 # would be equivalent to:
7648 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7649 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7650 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7651
7652
7653
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007654source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007655source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007656source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007657 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7659 yes | no | yes | yes
7660 Arguments :
7661 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7662 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007663
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007664 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007665 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7666 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7667 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7668 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7669 supported prefixes are :
7670 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7671 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7672 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007673 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007674 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7675 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007676
7677 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7678 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007679 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7680 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7681 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007682
7683 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7684 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7685 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7686 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7687 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7688 <addr>.
7689
7690 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7691 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7692 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7693 port.
7694
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007695 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7696 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7697 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7698 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007699 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007700 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7701 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7702 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7703 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7704 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7705 HTTP header.
7706
7707 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7708 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007709 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007710 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7711 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7712 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7713 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7714 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7715 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7716 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7717
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007718 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7719 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7720 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7721 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7722 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7723 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7724
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007725 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7726 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7727 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7728 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7729
7730 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7731 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7732 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7733 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7734 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7735 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7736
7737 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7738 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7739 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7740 there are two methods :
7741
7742 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7743 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7744 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7745 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7746 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7747 of the client ranges may be used.
7748
7749 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7750 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7751 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7752 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7753 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7754 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7755 same session.
7756
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007757 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7758 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7759 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007760 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007761
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007762 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7763
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007764 Examples :
7765 backend private
7766 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7767 source 192.168.1.200
7768
7769 backend transparent_ssl1
7770 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7771 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7772
7773 backend transparent_ssl2
7774 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7775 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7776 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7777
7778 backend transparent_ssl3
7779 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7780 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7781 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7782
7783 backend transparent_smtp
7784 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7785 # with Tproxy version 4.
7786 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7787
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007788 backend transparent_http
7789 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7790 # proxy.
7791 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007793 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007794 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7795
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007796
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007797srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7798 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7800 yes | no | yes | yes
7801 Arguments :
7802 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7803 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7804 as explained at the top of this document.
7805
7806 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7807 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7808 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7809 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7810 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7811 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7812 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7813
7814 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7815 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7816 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7817 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7818 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007819 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007820 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007821 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007822
7823 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7824 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7825 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7826 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7827 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7828 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7829
7830 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7831 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7832
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007833 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7834 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007835
7836
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007837stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7838 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007840 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007841
7842 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7843 matched.
7844
7845 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7846 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7847
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007848 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7849 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7850 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7851
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007852 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7853 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7854 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7855 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007856
7857 Example :
7858 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7859 backend stats_localhost
7860 stats enable
7861 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7862
7863 Example :
7864 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7865 backend stats_auth
7866 stats enable
7867 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7868 stats admin if TRUE
7869
7870 Example :
7871 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7872 userlist stats-auth
7873 group admin users admin
7874 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7875 group readonly users haproxy
7876 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7877
7878 backend stats_auth
7879 stats enable
7880 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7881 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7882 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7883 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7884
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007885 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7886 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7887 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007888
7889
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007890stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7891 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007893 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007894 Arguments :
7895 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7896
7897 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7898
7899 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7900 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7901 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7902 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7903 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7904 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7905
7906 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7907 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7908 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007909 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007910
7911 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7912 report using "stats scope".
7913
7914 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7915 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7916 unobvious parameters.
7917
7918 Example :
7919 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7920 backend public_www
7921 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7922 stats enable
7923 stats hide-version
7924 stats scope .
7925 stats uri /admin?stats
7926 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7927 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7928 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7929
7930 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7931 backend private_monitoring
7932 stats enable
7933 stats uri /admin?stats
7934 stats refresh 5s
7935
7936 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7937
7938
7939stats enable
7940 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007942 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007943 Arguments : none
7944
7945 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7946 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7947 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7948 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7949 - stats auth : no authentication
7950 - stats scope : no restriction
7951
7952 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7953 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7954 unobvious parameters.
7955
7956 Example :
7957 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7958 backend public_www
7959 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7960 stats enable
7961 stats hide-version
7962 stats scope .
7963 stats uri /admin?stats
7964 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7965 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7966 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7967
7968 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7969 backend private_monitoring
7970 stats enable
7971 stats uri /admin?stats
7972 stats refresh 5s
7973
7974 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7975
7976
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007977stats hide-version
7978 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007980 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007981 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007982
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007983 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7984 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7985 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7986 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7987 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7988 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007989
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007990 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7991 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7992 unobvious parameters.
7993
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007994 Example :
7995 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7996 backend public_www
7997 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007998 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007999 stats hide-version
8000 stats scope .
8001 stats uri /admin?stats
8002 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8003 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8004 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008005
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008006 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8007 backend private_monitoring
8008 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008009 stats uri /admin?stats
8010 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008011
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008012 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008013
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008014
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008015stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8016 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8017 Access control for statistics
8018
8019 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8020 no | no | yes | yes
8021
8022 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8023 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8024 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8025 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8026 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8027 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8028
8029 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8030 instance.
8031
8032 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8033 about ACL usage.
8034
8035
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008036stats realm <realm>
8037 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008039 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008040 Arguments :
8041 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8042 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8043 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8044
8045 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8046 using a backslash ('\').
8047
8048 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8049 only related to authentication.
8050
8051 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8052 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8053 unobvious parameters.
8054
8055 Example :
8056 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8057 backend public_www
8058 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8059 stats enable
8060 stats hide-version
8061 stats scope .
8062 stats uri /admin?stats
8063 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8064 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8065 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8066
8067 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8068 backend private_monitoring
8069 stats enable
8070 stats uri /admin?stats
8071 stats refresh 5s
8072
8073 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8074
8075
8076stats refresh <delay>
8077 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008079 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008080 Arguments :
8081 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8082 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8083 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8084 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8085 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8086 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8087
8088 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8089 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8090 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8091 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8092
8093 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8094 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8095 unobvious parameters.
8096
8097 Example :
8098 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8099 backend public_www
8100 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8101 stats enable
8102 stats hide-version
8103 stats scope .
8104 stats uri /admin?stats
8105 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8106 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8107 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8108
8109 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8110 backend private_monitoring
8111 stats enable
8112 stats uri /admin?stats
8113 stats refresh 5s
8114
8115 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8116
8117
8118stats scope { <name> | "." }
8119 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008121 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008122 Arguments :
8123 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8124 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8125 section in which the statement appears.
8126
8127 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8128 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8129 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8130 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8131 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8132 exists.
8133
8134 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8135 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8136 unobvious parameters.
8137
8138 Example :
8139 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8140 backend public_www
8141 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8142 stats enable
8143 stats hide-version
8144 stats scope .
8145 stats uri /admin?stats
8146 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8147 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8148 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8149
8150 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8151 backend private_monitoring
8152 stats enable
8153 stats uri /admin?stats
8154 stats refresh 5s
8155
8156 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8157
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008158
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008159stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008160 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008162 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008163
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008164 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008165 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8166
8167 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8168 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8169
8170 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8171 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008172 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008173
8174 Example :
8175 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8176 backend private_monitoring
8177 stats enable
8178 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8179 stats uri /admin?stats
8180 stats refresh 5s
8181
8182 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8183 global section.
8184
8185
8186stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008187 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8189 yes | yes | yes | yes
8190 Arguments : none
8191
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008192 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008193 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8194 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8195 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8196 - IP (socket, server)
8197 - cookie (backend, server)
8198
8199 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8200 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008201 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008202
8203 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8204
8205
8206stats show-node [ <name> ]
8207 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008209 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008210 Arguments:
8211 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8212 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8213
8214 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8215 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008216 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008217
8218 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8219 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8220 unobvious parameters.
8221
8222 Example:
8223 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8224 backend private_monitoring
8225 stats enable
8226 stats show-node Europe-1
8227 stats uri /admin?stats
8228 stats refresh 5s
8229
8230 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8231 section.
8232
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008233
8234stats uri <prefix>
8235 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008237 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008238 Arguments :
8239 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8240 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8241 query string.
8242
8243 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8244 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8245 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8246 possible to reach it in the application.
8247
8248 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008249 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008250 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8251 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8252 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8253 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8254
8255 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8256 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8257 an address or a port to statistics only.
8258
8259 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8260 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8261 unobvious parameters.
8262
8263 Example :
8264 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8265 backend public_www
8266 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8267 stats enable
8268 stats hide-version
8269 stats scope .
8270 stats uri /admin?stats
8271 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8272 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8273 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8274
8275 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8276 backend private_monitoring
8277 stats enable
8278 stats uri /admin?stats
8279 stats refresh 5s
8280
8281 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8282
8283
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008284stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8285 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008287 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008288
8289 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008290 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008291 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8292 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8293 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8294
8295 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8296 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8297 the "stick-table" statement.
8298
8299 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8300 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8301 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8302 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8303 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8304
8305 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8306 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8307 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8308 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8309 transformation rules.
8310
8311 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8312 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8313 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8314 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8315 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8316 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8317 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8318
8319 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8320 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8321 ACL based conditions.
8322
8323 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8324 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8325 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8326 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8327
8328 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8329 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8330 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8331 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8332
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008333 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8334 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8335 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8336
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008337 Example :
8338 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8339 # last 30 minutes
8340 backend pop
8341 mode tcp
8342 balance roundrobin
8343 stick store-request src
8344 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8345 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8346 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8347
8348 backend smtp
8349 mode tcp
8350 balance roundrobin
8351 stick match src table pop
8352 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8353 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8354
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008355 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008356 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008357
8358
8359stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8360 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8362 no | no | yes | yes
8363
8364 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8365 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8366 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8367 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8368
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008369 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8370 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8371 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8372
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008373 Examples :
8374 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008375 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008376
8377 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8378 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8379 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8380
8381
8382 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8383 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8384 backend http
8385 mode http
8386 balance roundrobin
8387 stick on src table https
8388 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8389 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8390 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8391
8392 backend https
8393 mode tcp
8394 balance roundrobin
8395 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8396 stick on src
8397 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8398 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8399
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008400 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008401
8402
8403stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8404 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8406 no | no | yes | yes
8407
8408 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008409 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008410 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8411 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8412 server is selected.
8413
8414 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8415 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8416 the "stick-table" statement.
8417
8418 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8419 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8420 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8421 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8422 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8423 address.
8424
8425 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8426 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8427 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8428 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8429 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8430 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8431 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8432 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8433 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8434 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8435
8436 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8437 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8438 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8439 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8440 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8441 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8442 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8443
8444 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8445 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8446 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8447 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8448
8449 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8450 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8451 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8452 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8453 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8454 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008455 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8456 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8457 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8458 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8459 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8460 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008461
8462 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8463 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8464 the request.
8465
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008466 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8467 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8468 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8469
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008470 Example :
8471 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8472 # last 30 minutes
8473 backend pop
8474 mode tcp
8475 balance roundrobin
8476 stick store-request src
8477 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8478 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8479 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8480
8481 backend smtp
8482 mode tcp
8483 balance roundrobin
8484 stick match src table pop
8485 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8486 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8487
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008488 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008489 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008490
8491
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008492stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008493 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8494 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008495 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008497 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008498
8499 Arguments :
8500 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8501 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8502 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8503 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8504
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008505 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8506 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8507 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8508 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8509
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008510 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8511 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8512 instance.
8513
8514 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8515 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8516 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8517 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8518 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8519 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008520 to 32 characters.
8521
8522 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8523 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8524 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008525 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008526 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8527 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008528
8529 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008530 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8531 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008532 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8533 increase.
8534
8535 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008536 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8537 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8538 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008539
8540 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8541 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8542 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8543 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8544 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8545 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8546 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8547 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8548 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8549 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8550 parameter (see below).
8551
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008552 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8553 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8554 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8555 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8556 soft restart.
8557
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008558 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8559 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008560
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008561 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8562 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8563 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8564 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008565 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008566 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008567 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8568 if not expiration delay is specified.
8569
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008570 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8571 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8572 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8573 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008574 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8575 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8576 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8577 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8578 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8579 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8580 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8581 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8582 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8583 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8584 types and their arguments.
8585
8586 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8587 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8588 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8589 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8590
8591 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8592 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8593 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8594 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8595
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008596 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8597 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8598 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8599 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8600 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8601 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8602
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008603 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8604 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8605 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8606 they were received.
8607
8608 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8609 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8610 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8611 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8612 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8613
8614 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8615 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8616 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8617 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8618 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8619
8620 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8621 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8622 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8623
8624 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8625 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8626 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8627 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8628 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8629
8630 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8631 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8632 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8633 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8634 the client side.
8635
8636 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8637 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8638 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8639 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8640 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8641 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8642 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8643
8644 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8645 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8646 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8647 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8648 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8649 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8650 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8651
8652 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8653 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8654 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8655 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8656 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8657 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8658
8659 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8660 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8661 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8662 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8663
8664 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8665 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8666 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8667 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8668 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8669 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8670 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8671 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8672 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8673 recommended for better fairness.
8674
8675 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8676 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8677 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8678 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8679
8680 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8681 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8682 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8683 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8684 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8685 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8686 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8687 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8688 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8689 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008690
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008691 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8692 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008693 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8694 reference it.
8695
8696 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8697 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008698 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8699 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8700 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008701
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008702 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8703 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8704 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8705 something that can be ignored.
8706
8707 Example:
8708 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8709 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8710 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8711 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8712
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008713 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008714 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008715
8716
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008717stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008718 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8720 no | no | yes | yes
8721
8722 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008723 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008724 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8725 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8726 server is selected.
8727
8728 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8729 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8730 the "stick-table" statement.
8731
8732 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8733 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8734 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8735 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8736
8737 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8738 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8739 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8740 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8741 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8742 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008743 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008744 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8745 rules.
8746
8747 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8748 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8749 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8750 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8751 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8752 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8753 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8754
8755 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8756 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8757 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8758 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8759
8760 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8761 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8762 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8763 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8764 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8765 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008766 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8767 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8768 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8769 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8770 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8771 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8772 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8773 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8774 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008775
8776 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8777
8778 Example :
8779 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8780 backend https
8781 mode tcp
8782 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008783 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008784 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008785
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008786 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8787 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8788
8789 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8790 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8791 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8792
8793 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8794 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008795
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008796 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8797 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8798 # at offset 44.
8799
8800 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8801 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8802
8803 # Learn on response if server hello.
8804 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008805
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008806 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8807 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8808
8809 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8810 extraction.
8811
8812
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008813tcp-check connect [params*]
8814 Opens a new connection
8815 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8816 no | no | yes | yes
8817
8818 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8819 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8820 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8821
8822 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8823 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8824 of the sequence.
8825
8826 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8827 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8828 do.
8829
8830 Parameters :
8831 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8832 use the TCP connection.
8833
8834 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8835 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8836 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8837
8838 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8839
8840 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8841
8842 Examples:
8843 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8844 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8845 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8846 option tcp-check
8847 tcp-check connect
8848 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8849 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8850 tcp-check send \r\n
8851 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8852 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8853 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8854 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8855 tcp-check send \r\n
8856 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8857 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8858
8859 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8860 option tcp-check
8861 tcp-check connect port 110
8862 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8863 tcp-check connect port 143
8864 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8865 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8866
8867 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8868
8869
8870tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8871 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8872 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8873 no | no | yes | yes
8874
8875 Arguments :
8876 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8877 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8878 binary.
8879 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8880 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8881 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8882
8883 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8884 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8885 with the usual backslash ('\').
8886 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8887 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8888 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8889 used upper or lower case.
8890
8891
8892 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8893
8894 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8895 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8896 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8897 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8898 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8899 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8900 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8901 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8902
8903 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8904 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8905 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8906 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8907 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8908 expression.
8909
8910 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8911 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8912 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8913 this exact hexadecimal string.
8914 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8915
8916 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8917 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8918 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8919 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8920 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8921 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8922 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8923 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8924 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8925 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8926 the null character.
8927
8928 Examples :
8929 # perform a POP check
8930 option tcp-check
8931 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8932
8933 # perform an IMAP check
8934 option tcp-check
8935 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8936
8937 # look for the redis master server
8938 option tcp-check
8939 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008940 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008941 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8942 tcp-check expect string role:master
8943 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8944 tcp-check expect string +OK
8945
8946
8947 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8948 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8949
8950
8951tcp-check send <data>
8952 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8953 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8954 no | no | yes | yes
8955
8956 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8957 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8958
8959 Examples :
8960 # look for the redis master server
8961 option tcp-check
8962 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8963 tcp-check expect string role:master
8964
8965 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8966 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8967
8968
8969tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8970 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8971 tcp health check
8972 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8973 no | no | yes | yes
8974
8975 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8976 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8977 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8978 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8979 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8980 hexadecimal string.
8981 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8982
8983 Examples :
8984 # redis check in binary
8985 option tcp-check
8986 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8987 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8988
8989
8990 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8991 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8992
8993
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008994tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8995 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8997 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008998 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008999 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9000 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009001
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009002 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009003
9004 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9005 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009006 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9007 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9008 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9009 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9010 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9011 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009012
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009013 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9014 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9015 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9016 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009017
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009018 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009019 - accept :
9020 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9021 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9022 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009023
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009024 - reject :
9025 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9026 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9027 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9028 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9029 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9030 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9031 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9032 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9033 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9034 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9035 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009036 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009037
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009038 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9039 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9040 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9041 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9042 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9043 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9044 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9045 hosts.
9046
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009047 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9048 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9049 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9050 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9051 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9052 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9053 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9054 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9055
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009056 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9057 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9058 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9059 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9060 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9061 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9062 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9063 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9064 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009065 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9066 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009067
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009068 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009069 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02009070 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009071 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009072 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9073 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009074 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009075 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
9076 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
9077 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
9078 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
9079 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009080
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009081 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009082 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009083 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009084 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
9085 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9086 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9087 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009088
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009089 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9090 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9091 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9092 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009093
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009094 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9095 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9096 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9097 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9098 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009099 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9100 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9101 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9102 layer7 information is extracted.
9103
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009104 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9105 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9106 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9107 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9108 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009109
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009110 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9111 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9112 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9113 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9114
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009115 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9116 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9117 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9118 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9119 continues.
9120
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009121 - set-src <expr> :
9122 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9123 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9124 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9125 set-src"
9126
9127 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9128 followed by some converters.
9129
9130 Example:
9131
9132 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9133
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009134 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9135 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009136
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009137 - set-src-port <expr> :
9138 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9139 expression.
9140
9141 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9142 followed by some converters.
9143
9144 Example:
9145
9146 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9147
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009148 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9149 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9150 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009151
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009152 - set-dst <expr> :
9153 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9154 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9155 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9156 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9157 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9158
9159 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9160 followed by some converters.
9161
9162 Example:
9163
9164 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9165 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9166
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009167 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9168 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9169
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009170 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9171 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9172 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9173 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9174
9175
9176 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9177 followed by some converters.
9178
9179 Example:
9180
9181 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9182
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009183 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9184 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9185 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9186
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009187 - "silent-drop" :
9188 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9189 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9190 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9191 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9192 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9193 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9194 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9195 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9196 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9197 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9198 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9199 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9200 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9201 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9202 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9203 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9204
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009205 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9206 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9207 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009208
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009209 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9210 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9211 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009212
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009213 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009214 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009215 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009216
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009217 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9218 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9219 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009220
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009221 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009222 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9223 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009224
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009225 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9226
9227 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9228
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009229 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9230
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009231 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009232
9233
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009234tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9235 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009237 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009238 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009239 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9240 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009241
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009242 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009243
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009244 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9245 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9246 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9247 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9248 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009249
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009250 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9251 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9252 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9253 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009254 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9255 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9256 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9257 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9258 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9259 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009260 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009261 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009262
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009263 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9264 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9265 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9266 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009267
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009268 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009269 - accept : the request is accepted
9270 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9271 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009272 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009273 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009274 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009275 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009276 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009277 - silent-drop
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009278 - send-spoe-group <engin-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009279
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009280 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9281 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009282
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009283 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9284 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9285 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9286 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9287 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9288 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009289
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009290 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009291 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9292 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009293
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009294 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009295 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9296 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9297 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9298 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009299 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9300 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9301 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009302
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009303 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009304 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9305 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9306 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009307
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009308 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009309 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9310 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009311
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009312 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9313 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009314 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009315 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9316 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009317 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009318 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009319 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009320 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9321 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009322 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009323 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9324 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009325
9326 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9327 followed by some converters.
9328
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009329 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9330 <var-name>.
9331
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009332 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9333 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9334 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9335 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9336 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9337
9338 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9339
9340 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9341
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009342 Example:
9343
9344 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009345 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009346
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009347 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009348 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9349 # and reject everything else.
9350 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9351 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009352 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009353 tcp-request content reject
9354
9355 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009356 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9357 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9358 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009359 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009360
9361 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9362 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9363 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009364 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009365 tcp-request content reject
9366
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009367 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009368 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009369 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009370 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009371 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9372 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009373
9374 Example:
9375 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9376 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009377 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009378
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009379 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009380 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009381
9382 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009383 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009384 # protecting all our sites
9385 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009386 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9387 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009388 ...
9389 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9390
9391 backend http_dynamic
9392 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009393 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009394 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009395 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009396 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009397 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009398 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009399
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009400 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009401
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009402 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9403 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009404
9405
9406tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9407 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009409 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009410 Arguments :
9411 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9412 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9413 as explained at the top of this document.
9414
9415 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9416 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9417 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9418 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9419 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9420
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009421 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9422 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9423 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9424 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9425
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009426 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9427 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009428 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009429 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009430 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9431 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9432 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9433 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009434
9435 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9436 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9437 it pass through unaffected.
9438
9439 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9440 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9441 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009442 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009443 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9444 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009445 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9446 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9447 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009448
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009449 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009450 "timeout client".
9451
9452
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009453tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9454 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9456 no | no | yes | yes
9457 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009458 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9459 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009460
9461 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9462
9463 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9464 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9465 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009466 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9467 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009468
9469 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9470
9471 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9472 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9473 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9474 inserted.
9475
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009476 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009477 - accept :
9478 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9479 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9480 the rules evaluation.
9481
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009482 - close :
9483 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9484 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9485 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9486 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9487 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9488 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009489 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009490 protocols.
9491
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009492 - reject :
9493 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9494 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009495 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009496
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009497 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9498 Sets a variable.
9499
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009500 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9501 Unsets a variable.
9502
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009503 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9504 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9505 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9506 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9507
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009508 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9509 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9510 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9511 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9512 continues.
9513
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009514 - "silent-drop" :
9515 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9516 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9517 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9518 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9519 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9520 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9521 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9522 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9523 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9524 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9525 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9526 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9527 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9528 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9529 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9530 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9531
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009532 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9533 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9534
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009535 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9536 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9537 for changing the default action to a reject.
9538
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009539 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9540 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9541 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9542 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009543 period.
9544
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009545 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9546 declared inline.
9547
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009548 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9549 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009550 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009551 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9552 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009553 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009554 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009555 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009556 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9557 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009558 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009559 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9560 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009561
9562 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9563 followed by some converters.
9564
9565 Example:
9566
9567 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9568
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009569 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9570 <var-name>.
9571
9572 Example:
9573
9574 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9575
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009576 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9577 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9578 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9579 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9580 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9581
9582 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9583
9584 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9585
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009586 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9587
9588 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9589
9590
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009591tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9592 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9594 no | yes | yes | no
9595 Arguments :
9596 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9597 below.
9598
9599 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9600
9601 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9602 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9603 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9604 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9605 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9606 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9607 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9608 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9609 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9610 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9611 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9612 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9613 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9614 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9615 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9616 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9617 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9618 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9619 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9620 instead.
9621
9622 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9623 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9624 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9625 rules which may be inserted.
9626
9627 Several types of actions are supported :
9628 - accept : the request is accepted
9629 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9630 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9631 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9632 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9633 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009634 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009635 - silent-drop
9636
9637 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9638 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9639 sections for a complete description.
9640
9641 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9642 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9643 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9644
9645 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9646 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9647 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9648 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9649 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9650
9651 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9652 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9653
9654 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9655 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9656 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9657
9658 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9659 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9660 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9661
9662 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9663 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9664 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9665
9666 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9667 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9668 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9669
9670 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9671
9672 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9673
9674
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009675tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9676 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9678 no | no | yes | yes
9679 Arguments :
9680 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9681 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9682 as explained at the top of this document.
9683
9684 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9685
9686
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009687timeout check <timeout>
9688 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9689 established.
9690
9691 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9692 yes | no | yes | yes
9693 Arguments:
9694 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9695 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9696 as explained at the top of this document.
9697
9698 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9699 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9700 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9701 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009702 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9703 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9704 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009705
9706 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9707 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9708
9709 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9710 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009711 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009712
9713 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9714 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9715 forget about it.
9716
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009717 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9718 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009719
9720
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009721timeout client <timeout>
9722timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9723 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9725 yes | yes | yes | no
9726 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009727 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009728 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9729 as explained at the top of this document.
9730
9731 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9732 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9733 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009734 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9735 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9736 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9737 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009738 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9739 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9740 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009741 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009742 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009743 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9744 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009745 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9746 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009747
9748 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9749 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9750 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9751 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9752 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9753 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9754
9755 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9756 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9757 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9758
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009759 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9760 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009761
9762
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009763timeout client-fin <timeout>
9764 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9766 yes | yes | yes | no
9767 Arguments :
9768 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9769 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9770 as explained at the top of this document.
9771
9772 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9773 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9774 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9775 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9776 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9777 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9778 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9779 down in one direction.
9780
9781 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9782 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9783 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9784
9785 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9786
9787
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009788timeout connect <timeout>
9789timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9790 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9792 yes | no | yes | yes
9793 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009794 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009795 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9796 as explained at the top of this document.
9797
9798 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009799 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009800 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009801 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009802 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9803 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009804
9805 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9806 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9807 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9808 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9809 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9810 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9811
9812 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9813 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9814 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9815
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009816 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9817 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009818
9819
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009820timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9821 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9823 yes | yes | yes | yes
9824 Arguments :
9825 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9826 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9827 as explained at the top of this document.
9828
9829 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9830 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9831 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9832 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9833 once the request has started to present itself.
9834
9835 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9836 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9837 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9838 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9839 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9840
9841 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9842 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9843 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9844 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9845
9846 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9847 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9848 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9849 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9850 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009851 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009852
9853 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9854 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9855 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9856 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9857
9858 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9859
9860
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009861timeout http-request <timeout>
9862 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009864 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009865 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009866 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009867 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9868 as explained at the top of this document.
9869
9870 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9871 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9872 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9873 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9874 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9875 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9876 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009877 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9878 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9879 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9880 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9881 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009882 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9883 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009884
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009885 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9886 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9887 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9888 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9889 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009890 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009891
9892 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9893 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9894 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9895 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9896 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9897
9898 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009899 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9900 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9901 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009902
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009903 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009904 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009905
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009906
9907timeout queue <timeout>
9908 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9910 yes | no | yes | yes
9911 Arguments :
9912 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9913 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9914 as explained at the top of this document.
9915
9916 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9917 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9918 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9919 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9920 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9921
9922 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9923 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9924 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9925 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9926
9927 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9928
9929
9930timeout server <timeout>
9931timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9932 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9934 yes | no | yes | yes
9935 Arguments :
9936 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9937 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9938 as explained at the top of this document.
9939
9940 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9941 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9942 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9943 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9944 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9945 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9946 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9947
9948 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9949 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9950 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9951 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9952 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009953 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009954 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009955 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9956 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9957 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9958 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009959
9960 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9961 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9962 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9963 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9964 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9965 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9966
9967 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9968 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9969 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9970
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009971 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009972
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009973
9974timeout server-fin <timeout>
9975 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9977 yes | no | yes | yes
9978 Arguments :
9979 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9980 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9981 as explained at the top of this document.
9982
9983 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9984 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9985 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9986 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9987 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9988 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9989 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9990 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9991 situations, it should not be needed.
9992
9993 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9994 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9995 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9996
9997 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9998
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009999
10000timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010001 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10003 yes | yes | yes | yes
10004 Arguments :
10005 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10006 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10007 as explained at the top of this document.
10008
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010009 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10010 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10011 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10012 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010013
10014 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10015 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10016 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10017 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010018 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010019
10020 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10021
10022
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010023timeout tunnel <timeout>
10024 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10026 yes | no | yes | yes
10027 Arguments :
10028 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10029 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10030 as explained at the top of this document.
10031
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010032 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010033 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10034 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10035 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
10036 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
10037 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
10038 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10039 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10040 specified.
10041
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010042 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10043 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10044 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10045 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10046 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10047 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10048 state.
10049
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010050 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10051 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10052 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10053 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
10054 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
10055
10056 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10057 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10058 forget about it.
10059
10060 Example :
10061 defaults http
10062 option http-server-close
10063 timeout connect 5s
10064 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010065 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010066 timeout server 30s
10067 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10068
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010069 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010070
10071
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010072transparent (deprecated)
10073 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010075 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010076 Arguments : none
10077
10078 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10079 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10080 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10081 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10082 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10083 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10084 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10085 appropriate server.
10086
10087 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10088
10089 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10090 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10091
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010092 See also: "option transparent"
10093
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010094unique-id-format <string>
10095 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10097 yes | yes | yes | no
10098 Arguments :
10099 <string> is a log-format string.
10100
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010101 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10102 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10103 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10104 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010105
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010106 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10107 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10108 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10109 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10110 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10111 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10112 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10113 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010114
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010115 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10116 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010117
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010118 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010119
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010120 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010121
10122 will generate:
10123
10124 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10125
10126 See also: "unique-id-header"
10127
10128unique-id-header <name>
10129 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10131 yes | yes | yes | no
10132 Arguments :
10133 <name> is the name of the header.
10134
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010135 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10136 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010137
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010138 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010139
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010140 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010141 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10142
10143 will generate:
10144
10145 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10146
10147 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010148
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010149use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010150 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10152 no | yes | yes | no
10153 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010154 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10155 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010156
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010157 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10158 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010159
10160 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10161 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10162 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010163 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
10164 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
10165 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10166 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010167
10168 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10169 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10170 assign the backend.
10171
10172 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10173 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10174 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10175 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10176 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10177 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10178
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010179 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010180 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010181 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10182 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10183 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10184
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010185 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10186 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10187 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10188 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10189 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10190 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10191 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10192 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10193 cannot be forced from the request.
10194
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010195 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010196 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10197 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10198
10199 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10200 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010201
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010202
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010203use-server <server> if <condition>
10204use-server <server> unless <condition>
10205 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10207 no | no | yes | yes
10208 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010209 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010210
10211 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10212
10213 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10214 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10215 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10216
10217 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10218 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10219 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10220 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10221 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10222 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10223 matches will assign the server.
10224
10225 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10226 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10227 with the next rules until one matches.
10228
10229 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10230 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10231 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10232 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10233
10234 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10235 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10236 stripped.
10237
10238 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10239 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10240 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10241 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10242
10243 Example :
10244 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10245 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10246 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10247 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10248 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10249 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010250 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010251 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10252 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10253
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010254 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010255
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010256
102575. Bind and Server options
10258--------------------------
10259
10260The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10261depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10262settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10263written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10264described in this section.
10265
10266
102675.1. Bind options
10268-----------------
10269
10270The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10271as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10272no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10273parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10274while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10275provided immediately after the setting name.
10276
10277The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10278
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010279accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10280 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10281 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10282 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10283 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10284 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10285 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10286 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10287 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10288 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010289 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10290 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10291 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010292
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010293accept-proxy
10294 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010295 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10296 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010297 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10298 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10299 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10300 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10301 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10302 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10303 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010304 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10305 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010306
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010307allow-0rtt
10308 Allow receiving early data when using TLS 1.3. This is disabled by default,
10309 due to security considerations.
10310
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010311alpn <protocols>
10312 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10313 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10314 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10315 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10316 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10317 initial NPN extension.
10318
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010319backlog <backlog>
10320 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10321 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10322
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010323curves <curves>
10324 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10325 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10326 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10327 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10328 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10329 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10330
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010331ecdhe <named curve>
10332 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010333 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10334 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010335
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010336ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010337 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10338 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10339 client's certificate.
10340
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010341ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10342 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10343 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10344 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10345 error is ignored.
10346
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010347ca-sign-file <cafile>
10348 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10349 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10350 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10351 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10352 'generate-certificates' for details.
10353
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010354ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010355 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10356 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10357 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10358 'generate-certificates' for details.
10359
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010360ciphers <ciphers>
10361 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10362 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010363 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010364 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10365 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
Daniel Schneller87e43022017-09-01 19:29:57 +020010366 Depending on the compatiblity and security requirements, the list of suitable
10367 ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background information and
10368 recommendations see e. g. (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS)
10369 and (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010370
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010371crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010372 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10373 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10374 to verify client's certificate.
10375
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010376crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010377 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10378 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10379 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10380 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10381 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10382 file.
10383
10384 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10385 are loaded.
10386
10387 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010388 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010389 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10390 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10391 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10392 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10393 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10394 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10395 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010396
10397 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10398 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10399 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10400 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010401 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10402 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010403
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010404 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010405
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010406 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10407 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010408 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010409 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10410 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10411 clients).
10412
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010413 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10414 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10415 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10416 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10417 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10418 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10419 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10420 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10421 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10422 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10423 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10424 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10425 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10426
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010427 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10428 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10429 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10430 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10431 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10432
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010433 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10434 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10435 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10436 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010437
10438 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10439 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10440 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10441 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10442 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10443 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10444 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10445 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10446 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10447
10448 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10449
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010450 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010451 a cert bundle.
10452
10453 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10454 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10455 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10456 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10457 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10458 provide multi-cert support.
10459
10460 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10461
10462 Filename | CN | SAN
10463 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10464 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010465 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010466 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10467 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10468
10469 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10470 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10471 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10472 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010473 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10474 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10475 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010476
10477 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10478 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10479
10480 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10481 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10482 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10483
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010484crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010485 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10486 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010487 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010488 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010489
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010490crt-list <file>
10491 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010492 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10493 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010494
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010495 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10496
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010497 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10498 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010499 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010500 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010501
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010502 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10503 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10504 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10505 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10506 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10507 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10508 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10509 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010510
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010511 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010512 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010513 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10514 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10515 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010516
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010517 crt-list file example:
10518 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010519 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010520 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010521 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010522
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010523defer-accept
10524 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10525 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10526 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10527 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10528 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10529 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10530 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10531 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10532 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10533 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10534 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10535
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010536expose-fd listeners
10537 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10538 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010539 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10540 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010541 See alors "-x" in the management guide.
10542
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010543force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010544 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010545 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010546 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010547 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010548
10549force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010550 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010551 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010552 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010553
10554force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010555 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010556 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010557 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010558
10559force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010560 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010561 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010562 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010563
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010564force-tlsv13
10565 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10566 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010567 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010568
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010569generate-certificates
10570 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10571 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10572 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10573 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10574 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10575 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10576 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10577 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10578 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10579 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10580 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10581
10582 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10583 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10584 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10585 certificate is used many times.
10586
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010587gid <gid>
10588 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10589 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10590 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10591 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10592 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10593
10594group <group>
10595 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10596 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10597 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10598 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10599 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10600
10601id <id>
10602 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10603 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10604 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10605 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10606
10607interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010608 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10609 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10610 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10611 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10612 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10613 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10614 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010615
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010616level <level>
10617 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10618 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10619 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10620 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10621 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10622 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10623 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10624 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10625 counters).
10626 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10627 all counters).
10628
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020010629severity-output <format>
10630 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
10631 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
10632 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
10633 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
10634 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
10635 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
10636 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
10637 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
10638 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
10639 rfc5424 convention.
10640
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010641maxconn <maxconn>
10642 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10643 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10644 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10645 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10646 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10647 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10648 eat all memory.
10649
10650mode <mode>
10651 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10652 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10653 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10654 UNIX sockets.
10655
10656mss <maxseg>
10657 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10658 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10659 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10660 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10661 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10662 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10663 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10664 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10665 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10666 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10667 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10668
10669name <name>
10670 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10671 page.
10672
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010673namespace <name>
10674 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10675 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10676 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10677 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10678
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010679nice <nice>
10680 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10681 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10682 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10683 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10684 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10685 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10686 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10687 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10688 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10689 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10690 one for an RDP socket.
10691
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010692no-ca-names
10693 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10694 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
10695
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010696no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010697 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010698 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010699 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010700 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010701 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
10702 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010703
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010704no-tls-tickets
10705 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10706 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10707 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010708 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10709 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010710
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010711no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010712 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010713 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010714 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010715 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010716 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10717 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010718
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010719no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010720 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010721 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010722 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010723 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010724 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10725 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010726
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010727no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010728 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010729 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010730 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010731 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010732 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10733 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010734
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010735no-tlsv13
10736 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10737 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
10738 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
10739 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010740 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10741 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010742
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010743npn <protocols>
10744 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10745 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10746 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10747 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010748 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10749 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010750
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000010751prefer-client-ciphers
10752 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
10753 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
10754 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
10755
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010756process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10757 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10758 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10759 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10760 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10761 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10762 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10763 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010764 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10765 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10766 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10767 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10768 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10769 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10770 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010771
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010772ssl
10773 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010774 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010775 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10776 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020010777 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
10778 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010779
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010780ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10781 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
10782 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10783 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
10784
10785ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10786 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
10787 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10788 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
10789
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010790strict-sni
10791 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10792 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10793 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10794 See the "crt" option for more information.
10795
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010796tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010797 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010798 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10799 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010800 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010801 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10802 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10803 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10804 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10805 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10806 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10807 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10808
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010809tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010810 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010811 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10812 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10813 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10814 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10815 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10816 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10817 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010818 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10819 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10820 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010821
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010822tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10823 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10824 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10825 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10826 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10827 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10828 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10829 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10830 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10831 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10832 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10833
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010834transparent
10835 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10836 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10837 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10838 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10839 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10840 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10841 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10842 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10843 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10844 so check for support with your vendor.
10845
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010846v4v6
10847 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10848 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10849 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10850 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010851 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010852
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010853v6only
10854 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10855 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10856 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010857 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10858 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010859
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010860uid <uid>
10861 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10862 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10863 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10864 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10865 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10866
10867user <user>
10868 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10869 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10870 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10871 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10872 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10873
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010874verify [none|optional|required]
10875 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10876 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10877 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10878 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10879 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010880 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10881 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10882 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10883 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010884
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200108855.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010886------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010887
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010888The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10889which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10890arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10891settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10892after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10893Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10894address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010895
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010896 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010897 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010898
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010899Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
10900keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
10901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010902The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010903
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010904addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010905 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010906 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10907 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10908 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10909 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10910 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010911
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010912agent-check
10913 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010914 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10915 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10916 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10917 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010918
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010919 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010920 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010921 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10922 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10923 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010924
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010925 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10926 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10927 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10928 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10929 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10930
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010931 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10932 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010933
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010934 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10935 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10936 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010937
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010938 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10939 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10940 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010941
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010942 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10943 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10944 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10945 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10946 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10947 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10948 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010949
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010950 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10951 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010952
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010953 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10954 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10955 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10956 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10957 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10958 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10959 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10960 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10961 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010962
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010963 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10964 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010965 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10966 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10967 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010968 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010969
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010970 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010971 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010972
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010973agent-send <string>
10974 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10975 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10976 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10977 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10978 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10979
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010980agent-inter <delay>
10981 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10982 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10983
10984 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10985 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10986 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10987 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10988 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10989 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10990 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10991 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10992 of backends use the same servers.
10993
10994 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10995
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010010996agent-addr <addr>
10997 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
10998
10999 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11000 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11001 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11002 hostname, it will be resolved.
11003
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011004agent-port <port>
11005 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11006
11007 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011009backup
11010 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11011 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11012 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11013 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011014 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11015 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011016
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011017ca-file <cafile>
11018 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11019 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11020 server's certificate.
11021
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011022check
11023 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011024 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11025 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11026 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11027 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11028 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11029 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11030 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011031 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11032 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011033 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11034 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011035
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011036check-send-proxy
11037 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11038 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11039 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11040 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11041 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11042 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11043 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11044
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011045check-sni
11046 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
11047 over SSL.
11048
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011049check-ssl
11050 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11051 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11052 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11053 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011054 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011055 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11056 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
11057 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011058 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11059 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011060
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011061ciphers <ciphers>
11062 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011063 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011064 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11065 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11066 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11067 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11068 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11069 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11070
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011071cookie <value>
11072 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11073 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11074 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11075 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11076 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11077 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11078 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11079
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011080crl-file <crlfile>
11081 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11082 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11083 to verify server's certificate.
11084
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011085crt <cert>
11086 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11087 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11088 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11089 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11090 certificate request.
11091
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011092disabled
11093 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11094 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11095 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11096 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11097 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011098 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011099
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011100enabled
11101 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11102 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11103 default value.
11104 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11105 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011106
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011107error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011108 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11109 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11110 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011111
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011112 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011113
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011114fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011115 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11116 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11117 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11118
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011119force-sslv3
11120 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11121 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011122 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011123 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011124
11125force-tlsv10
11126 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011127 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011128 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011129
11130force-tlsv11
11131 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011132 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011133 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011134
11135force-tlsv12
11136 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011137 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011138 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011139
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011140force-tlsv13
11141 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11142 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011143 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011145id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011146 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11147 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11148 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011149
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011150init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11151 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11152 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
11153 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
11154 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11155 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11156 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11157 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11158 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11159 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11160 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11161 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11162 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
11163 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
11164 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11165 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11166 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11167 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11168 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11169 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
11170 historic behaviour.
11171
11172 Example:
11173 defaults
11174 # never fail on address resolution
11175 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11176
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011177inter <delay>
11178fastinter <delay>
11179downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011180 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11181 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11182 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11183 between checks depending on the server state :
11184
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011185 Server state | Interval used
11186 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11187 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11188 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11189 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11190 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11191 or yet unchecked. |
11192 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11193 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11194 | "inter" otherwise.
11195 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011196
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011197 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11198 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11199 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11200 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011201 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11202 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11203 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11204 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11205 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011206
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011207maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011208 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11209 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11210 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11211 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11212 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11213 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11214 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11215 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11216
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011217maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011218 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11219 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11220 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11221 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11222 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11223 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11224 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11225
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011226minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011227 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11228 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11229 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11230 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11231 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11232 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011233 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011234 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011235
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011236namespace <name>
11237 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11238 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11239 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11240 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11241
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011242no-agent-check
11243 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11244 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11245 default value.
11246 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11247 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11248
11249no-backup
11250 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11251 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11252 default value.
11253 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11254 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11255
11256no-check
11257 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11258 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11259 default value.
11260 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11261 "default-server" "check" setting.
11262
11263no-check-ssl
11264 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11265 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11266 default value.
11267 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11268 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11269
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011270no-send-proxy
11271 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11272 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11273 default value.
11274 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11275 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11276
11277no-send-proxy-v2
11278 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11279 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11280 default value.
11281 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11282 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11283
11284no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11285 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11286 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11287 default value.
11288 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11289 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11290
11291no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11292 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11293 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11294 default value.
11295 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11296 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11297
11298no-ssl
11299 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11300 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11301 default value.
11302 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11303 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11304
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011305no-ssl-reuse
11306 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11307 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11308 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11309 and for paranoid users.
11310
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011311no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011312 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11313 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011314 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011315
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011316 Supported in default-server: No
11317
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011318no-tls-tickets
11319 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11320 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11321 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011322 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11323 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011324 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011325
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011326no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011327 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011328 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11329 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011330 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11331 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011332 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011333
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011334 Supported in default-server: No
11335
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011336no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011337 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011338 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11339 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011340 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11341 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011342 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011343
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011344 Supported in default-server: No
11345
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011346no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011347 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011348 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11349 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011350 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11351 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011352 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011353
11354 Supported in default-server: No
11355
11356no-tlsv13
11357 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11358 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11359 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11360 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11361 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011362 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011363
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011364 Supported in default-server: No
11365
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011366no-verifyhost
11367 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11368 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11369 default value.
11370 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11371 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011372
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011373non-stick
11374 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11375 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11376 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11377
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011378observe <mode>
11379 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11380 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11381 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11382 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11383 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11384 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011385 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011386
11387 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11388
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011389on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011390 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11391 Currently, four modes are available:
11392 - fastinter: force fastinter
11393 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11394 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11395 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11396 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11397
11398 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11399
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011400on-marked-down <action>
11401 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11402 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011403 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11404 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11405 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11406 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11407 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11408 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11409 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11410 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011411
11412 Actions are disabled by default
11413
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011414on-marked-up <action>
11415 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11416 Currently one action is available:
11417 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11418 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11419 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11420 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11421 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11422 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11423 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11424 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11425
11426 Actions are disabled by default
11427
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011428port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011429 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11430 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11431 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11432 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11433 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11434 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11435
11436redir <prefix>
11437 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11438 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11439 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11440 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11441 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11442 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11443 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11444 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011445 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011446 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11447 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11448 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11449 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11450 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11451
11452 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11453
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011454rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011455 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11456 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11457 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11458
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011459resolve-prefer <family>
11460 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11461 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11462 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11463 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11464
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011465 Default value: ipv6
11466
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011467 Example:
11468
11469 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011470
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011471resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11472 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11473 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011474 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011475 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11476 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11477 configured network, another address is selected.
11478
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011479 Example:
11480
11481 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011482
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011483resolvers <id>
11484 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11485 hostname.
11486
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011487 Example:
11488
11489 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011490
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011491 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011492
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011493send-proxy
11494 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11495 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11496 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11497 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011498 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11499 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11500 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11501 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11502 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11503 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11504 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11505 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11506 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11507 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011508 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11509 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011510
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011511send-proxy-v2
11512 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11513 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11514 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11515 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020011516 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
11517 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
11518 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
11519 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011520
11521send-proxy-v2-ssl
11522 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11523 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11524 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11525 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11526 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11527 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11528 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011529 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11530 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011531
11532send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11533 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11534 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11535 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11536 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11537 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11538 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11539 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11540 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011541 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and the
11542 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011543
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011544slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011545 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11546 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11547 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11548 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11549 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11550 parameters :
11551
11552 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11553 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11554
11555 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11556 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11557 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11558 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11559
11560 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11561 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11562 seen as failed.
11563
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011564sni <expression>
11565 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11566 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11567 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11568 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020011569 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
11570 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011571 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
11572 "verify" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011573
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011574source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011575source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011576source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011577 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11578 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11579 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11580 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11581
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011582 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11583 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11584 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11585 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11586 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11587 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11588 server.
11589
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011590 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11591 specifying the source address without port(s).
11592
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011593ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011594 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11595 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11596 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11597 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11598 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11599 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011600 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11601 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011602
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011603ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11604 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
11605 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11606 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11607
11608ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11609 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
11610 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11611 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11612
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011613ssl-reuse
11614 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11615 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11616 default value.
11617 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11618 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11619
11620stick
11621 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11622 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11623 default value.
11624 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11625 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011626
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011627tcp-ut <delay>
11628 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11629 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11630 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011631 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011632 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11633 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11634 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11635 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11636 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11637 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11638 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11639 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11640 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011642track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011643 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11644 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11645 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11646 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011647 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11648
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011649tls-tickets
11650 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11651 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11652 default value.
11653 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11654 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011655
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011656verify [none|required]
11657 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011658 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011659 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
11660 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
11661 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributs match either
11662 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
11663 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
11664 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
11665 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
11666 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
11667 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
11668 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
11669 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011670
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011671verifyhost <hostname>
11672 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011673 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
11674 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
11675 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
11676 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
11677 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
11678 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
11679 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
11680 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011681
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011682weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011683 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11684 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11685 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011686 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11687 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11688 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11689 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11690 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11691 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011692
11693
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200116945.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11695-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011696
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011697HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11698using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11699configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011700This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11701can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11702workload.
11703This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11704resolution at run time.
11705Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11706carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11707
11708
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200117095.3.1. Global overview
11710----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011711
11712As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11713different steps of the process life:
11714
11715 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11716 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11717 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11718
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011719 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
11720 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011721
11722A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11723 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11724 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11725 resolution to know this new IP.
11726
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011727When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
11728HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
11729SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
11730from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
11731will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
11732will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020011733
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011734A few things important to notice:
11735 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11736 first valid response.
11737
11738 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11739 servers return an error.
11740
11741
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200117425.3.2. The resolvers section
11743----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011744
11745This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011746HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
11747contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011748
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011749When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11750uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11751is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11752answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11753
11754When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011755used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011756
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011757 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
11758 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
11759 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011760
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011761 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
11762 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011763
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011764 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
11765 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
11766 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011767
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011768For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
11769following scenarios are possible:
11770
11771 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
11772 ignored
11773
11774 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11775 applied
11776
11777 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11778 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
11779
11780 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
11781 retries the query with a new type
11782
11783 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
11784 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011785
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011786As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
11787a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011788<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011789
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011790
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011791resolvers <resolvers id>
11792 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11793
11794A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11795
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011796accepted_payload_size <nb>
11797 Defines the maxium payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011798 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011799 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
11800 by RFC 6891)
11801
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020011802 Note: to get bigger responses but still be sure that responses won't be
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011803 dropped on the wire, one can choose a value between 1280 and 1410.
11804
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020011805 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
11806
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011807nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11808 DNS server description:
11809 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11810 <ip> : IP address of the server
11811 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11812
11813hold <status> <period>
11814 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11815 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011816 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011817 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011818 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11819 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11820 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11821
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020011822 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011823
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011824resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020011825 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
11826 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
11827 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
11828
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011829resolve_retries <nb>
11830 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11831 giving up.
11832 Default value: 3
11833
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011834 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11835 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11836 type.
11837
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011838timeout <event> <time>
11839 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11840 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11841 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011842 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
11843 other time applied.
11844 Default value: 1s
11845 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
11846 have been received.
11847 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011848 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11849 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11850
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011851 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011852
11853 resolvers mydns
11854 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11855 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11856 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011857 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011858 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011859 hold other 30s
11860 hold refused 30s
11861 hold nx 30s
11862 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011863 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011864 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011865
11866
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118676. HTTP header manipulation
11868---------------------------
11869
11870In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11871response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11872request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11873which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011874against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011875
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011876If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11877to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11878but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11879HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11880stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11881because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11882a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11883still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011884
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011885This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11886in section 4.2 :
11887
11888 - reqadd <string>
11889 - reqallow <search>
11890 - reqiallow <search>
11891 - reqdel <search>
11892 - reqidel <search>
11893 - reqdeny <search>
11894 - reqideny <search>
11895 - reqpass <search>
11896 - reqipass <search>
11897 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11898 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11899 - reqtarpit <search>
11900 - reqitarpit <search>
11901 - rspadd <string>
11902 - rspdel <search>
11903 - rspidel <search>
11904 - rspdeny <search>
11905 - rspideny <search>
11906 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11907 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11908
11909With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11910is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11911parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11912prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11913Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11914
11915 \t for a tab
11916 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11917 \n for a new line (LF)
11918 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11919 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11920 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11921 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11922 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11923
11924The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11925portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11926above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11927regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
119289 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11929is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11930
11931The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11932after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11933
11934Notes related to these keywords :
11935---------------------------------
11936 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11937 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11938 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11939
11940 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11941 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11942 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11943
11944 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11945 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11946 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11947 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11948 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11949
11950 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11951 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11952 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11953 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11954 useless headers before adding new ones.
11955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011956 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011957 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11958
11959 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11960 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11961 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11962
11963 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11964 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011965 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011966
11967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11969----------------------------------
11970
11971Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11972client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11973The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11974these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11975but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11976data called patterns.
11977
11978
119797.1. ACL basics
11980---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011981
11982The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11983content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11984from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11985simple :
11986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011987 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011988 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011989 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11990 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011992The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11993adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011994
11995In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011997 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011998
11999This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12000Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12001and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012002an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12003conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12004as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12005are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012006
12007ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12008'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12009which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12010
12011There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12012performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012014The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12015specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12016this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012017methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12018ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012019
12020Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12021 - boolean
12022 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12023 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12024 - string
12025 - data block
12026
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012027Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12028converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12029would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12030The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12031which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12032
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012033Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12034keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12035fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12036which are summarized in the table below :
12037
12038 +---------------------+-----------------+
12039 | Sample or converter | Default |
12040 | output type | matching method |
12041 +---------------------+-----------------+
12042 | boolean | bool |
12043 +---------------------+-----------------+
12044 | integer | int |
12045 +---------------------+-----------------+
12046 | ip | ip |
12047 +---------------------+-----------------+
12048 | string | str |
12049 +---------------------+-----------------+
12050 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12051 +---------------------+-----------------+
12052
12053Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12054matching method, see below.
12055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012056The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12057 - boolean
12058 - integer or integer range
12059 - IP address / network
12060 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12061 - regular expression
12062 - hex block
12063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012064The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12065
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012066 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12067 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012068 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012069 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012070 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012071 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012072 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012074The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12075read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12076if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12077lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12078will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12079beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12080a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12081lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12082exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12083
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012084The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12085parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12086ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12087a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12088check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12089
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012090The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12091socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12092file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012094Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12095loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12096
12097 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12098
12099In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12100the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12101case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12102as well.
12103
12104The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12105sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12106do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12107methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12108is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
12109obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
12110followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12111default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12112that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12113string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12114
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012115The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12116By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12117string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12118resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12119server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12120waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12121flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12122function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012124There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12125sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12126be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012127
12128 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12129 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012130 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12131 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12132 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12133 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012134
12135 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12136 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012137 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012138
12139 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012140 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012141
12142 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012143 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012144
12145 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
12146 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12147
12148 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12149 binary or string samples.
12150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012151 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12152 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012154 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12155 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12156 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012158 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12159 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012161 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12162 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012164 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12165 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012167 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12168 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012169 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012171 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12172 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12173 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012174
12175For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12176request, it is possible to do :
12177
12178 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12179
12180In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12181buffer, one would use the following acl :
12182
12183 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12184
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012185On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12186possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12187
12188 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012190All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12191criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12192method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12193to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12194criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12195the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012197If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012198the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12199For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012201 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12202 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12203 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12204 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012205
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012206
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012207The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12208types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12209combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12210brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12211default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012213 +-------------------------------------------------+
12214 | Input sample type |
12215 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012216 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012217 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12218 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12219 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012220 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012221 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012222 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012223 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012224 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012225 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012226 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012227 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012228 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012229 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012230 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012231 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012232 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012233 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012234 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012235 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012236 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012237 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012238 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012239 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012240 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012241 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12242 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12243 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012244
12245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200122467.1.1. Matching booleans
12247------------------------
12248
12249In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12250Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12251When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12252that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12253
12254Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12255return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12256"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12257
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200122597.1.2. Matching integers
12260------------------------
12261
12262Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12263enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12264to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12265
12266Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12267matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12268lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012269
12270For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12271unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12272representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12273
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012274As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12275two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12276instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12277ranges and operators.
12278
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012279For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012280operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12281Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12282of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012283
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012284Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012285
12286 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12287 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12288 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12289 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12290 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12291
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012292For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012293
12294 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12295
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012296This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12297
12298 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12299
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123017.1.3. Matching strings
12302-----------------------
12303
12304String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12305different forms :
12306
12307 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
12308 patterns ;
12309
12310 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
12311 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
12312
12313 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12314 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12315
12316 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12317 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12318
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012319 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012320 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12321 matches.
12322
12323 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12324 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12325 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012326
12327String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12328exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12329characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12330string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12331to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012332before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012333
12334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123357.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12336---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012337
12338Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12339they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12340possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12341passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12342the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012343the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12344match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012345
12346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123477.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12348-------------------------------------
12349
12350It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12351not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12352a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12353to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12354digits may be used upper or lower case.
12355
12356Example :
12357 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12358 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12359
12360
123617.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12362---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012363
12364IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12365netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12366within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012367host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012368difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12369at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12370does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12371parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012372
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012373The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12374abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12375
12376 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12377 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12378 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12379 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12380 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12381 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12382 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12383 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12384
12385Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12386192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12387
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012388IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12389Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12390trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12391IPv6 patterns.
12392
12393HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12394following situations :
12395 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12396 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12397 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12398 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12399 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12400 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12401 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12402 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12403 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12404 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012406
124077.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12408----------------------------------
12409
12410Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12411combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12412
12413 - AND (implicit)
12414 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12415 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012417A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012419 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012421Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12422indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012424For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12425"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12426requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12427is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12428
12429 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012430 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12431 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12432 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012433
12434To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12435and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12436
12437 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12438 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12439 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12440 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12441
12442 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12443 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12444 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12445 use_backend www if host_www
12446
12447It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12448expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12449be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12450the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12451
12452 The following rule :
12453
12454 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012455 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012456
12457 Can also be written that way :
12458
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012459 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012460
12461It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12462to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12463simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12464sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12465good use is the following :
12466
12467 With named ACLs :
12468
12469 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12470 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12471 monitor fail if site_dead
12472
12473 With anonymous ACLs :
12474
12475 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12476
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012477See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12478keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012479
12480
124817.3. Fetching samples
12482---------------------
12483
12484Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12485against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12486sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12487ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12488of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12489available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12490
12491This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12492Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12493compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12494deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12495
12496The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12497matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12498method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12499indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12500
12501As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12502when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12503mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12504the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12505ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12506
12507Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12508multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12509when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12510incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12511are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12512is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12513all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12514
12515Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12516 - name
12517 - name(arg1)
12518 - name(arg1,arg2)
12519
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012520
125217.3.1. Converters
12522-----------------
12523
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012524Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12525of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12526is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12527was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12528has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12529unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12530
12531These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12532sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12533the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12534support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012535
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012536A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12537support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12538supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12539(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12540bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012542The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012543
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001254451d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12545 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12546 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12547 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12548 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12549 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12550
12551 Example :
12552 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12553 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12554 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12555 frontend http-in
12556 bind *:8081
12557 default_backend servers
12558 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12559 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12560
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012561add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012562 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012563 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012564 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12565 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012566 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012567 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12568 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12569 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12570 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12571 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012572 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012573
12574and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012575 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012576 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012577 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12578 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012579 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012580 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12581 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12582 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12583 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12584 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012585 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012586
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020012587b64dec
12588 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
12589 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
12590
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012591base64
12592 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12593 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12594 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12595
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012596bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012597 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012598 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12599 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12600 presence of a flag).
12601
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012602bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12603 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12604 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012605 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012606
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012607cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012608 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12609 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012610
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012611crc32([<avalanche>])
12612 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12613 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12614 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12615 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12616 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12617 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12618 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12619 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12620 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12621 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12622 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12623
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012624da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012625 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12626 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12627 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12628 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012629 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012630 configuration language.
12631
12632 Example:
12633 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012634 bind *:8881
12635 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012636 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012637
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012638debug
12639 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12640 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12641 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12642
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012643div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012644 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12645 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012646 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012647 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12648 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012649 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012650 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12651 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12652 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12653 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12654 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012655 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012656
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012657djb2([<avalanche>])
12658 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12659 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12660 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12661 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12662 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12663 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12664 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012665 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12666 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012667
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012668even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012669 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012670 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12671
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012672field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12673 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12674 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12675 list of chars.
12676
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012677hex
12678 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12679 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12680 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12681 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012682
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020012683hex2i
12684 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
12685 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
12686
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012687http_date([<offset>])
12688 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12689 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12690 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12691 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12692 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12693 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012694
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012695in_table(<table>)
12696 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12697 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12698 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12699 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12700 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12701
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012702ipmask(<mask>)
12703 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12704 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12705 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12706 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12707
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012708json([<input-code>])
12709 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12710 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012711 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012712 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12713 of errors:
12714 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12715 bytes, ...)
12716 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12717 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12718
12719 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12720 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12721 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12722 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12723 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12724 are :
12725 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12726 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12727 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12728 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12729 error ;
12730 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12731 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12732
12733 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12734 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12735
12736 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012737 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012738 capture request header user-agent len 150
12739 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012740
12741 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12742 GET / HTTP/1.0
12743 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12744
12745 Output log:
12746 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12747
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012748language(<value>[,<default>])
12749 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12750 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12751 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12752 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12753 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12754 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12755 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12756 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12757 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12758 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12759 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12760 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012761
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012762 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012763
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012764 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12765 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012766
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012767 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12768 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12769 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12770 use_backend spanish if es
12771 use_backend french if fr
12772 use_backend english if en
12773 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012774
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012775lower
12776 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12777 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12778 type. The result is of type string.
12779
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012780ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12781 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12782 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12783 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12784 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12785 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12786 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12787
12788 Example :
12789
12790 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12791 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12792 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12793
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012794map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12795map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12796map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12797 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12798 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12799 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12800 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12801 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12802 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12803 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12804 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012805
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012806 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12807 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12808 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012809
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012810 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012811 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012812
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012813 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12814 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12815 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12816 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012817 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12818 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012819 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12820 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12821 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12822 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12823 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12824 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12825 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12826 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012827 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12828 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12829 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012830 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12831 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12832 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12833 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12834 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012835
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012836 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12837 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12838 the corresponding match text.
12839
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012840 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12841 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12842 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12843 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12844 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012845
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012846 Example :
12847
12848 # this is a comment and is ignored
12849 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12850 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12851 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12852 | | | `---------- value
12853 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12854 | `---------------------------- key
12855 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12856
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012857mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012858 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12859 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012860 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012861 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012862 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012863 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12864 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12865 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12866 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12867 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012868 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012869
12870mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012871 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012872 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12873 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012874 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012875 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012876 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012877 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12878 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12879 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12880 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12881 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012882 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012883
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010012884nbsrv
12885 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
12886 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
12887 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
12888 map lookup.
12889
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012890neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012891 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12892 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12893 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12894 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012895
12896not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012897 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012898 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12899 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12900 absence of a flag).
12901
12902odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012903 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012904 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12905
12906or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012907 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012908 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012909 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12910 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012911 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012912 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12913 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12914 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12915 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12916 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012917 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012918
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012919regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012920 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12921 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12922 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12923 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12924 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12925 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12926 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12927 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12928 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12929 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012930 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12931 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12932 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12933 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012934
12935 Example :
12936
12937 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12938 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12939 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12940 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12941
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012942capture-req(<id>)
12943 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12944 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12945
12946 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012947 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12948 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012949
12950capture-res(<id>)
12951 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12952 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12953
12954 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012955 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12956 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012957
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012958sdbm([<avalanche>])
12959 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12960 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12961 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12962 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12963 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12964 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12965 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012966 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12967 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012968
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012969set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012970 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12971 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12972 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012973 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012974 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12975 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012976 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012977 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12978 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012979 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012980 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012981
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020012982sha1
12983 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
12984 sample with length of 20 bytes.
12985
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012986sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012987 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12988 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012989 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012990 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12991 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012992 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012993 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12994 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012995 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012996 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12997 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012998 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012999 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013000
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013001table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13002 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13003 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13004 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13005 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13006 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13007 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13008
13009
13010table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13011 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13012 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13013 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13014 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13015 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13016 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13017
13018table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13019 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13020 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13021 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
13022 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13023 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13024
13025table_conn_cur(<table>)
13026 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13027 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13028 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13029 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13030 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13031
13032table_conn_rate(<table>)
13033 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13034 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13035 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13036 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13037 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13038
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013039table_gpt0(<table>)
13040 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13041 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13042 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13043 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13044 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13045
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013046table_gpc0(<table>)
13047 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13048 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13049 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13050 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13051 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13052
13053table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13054 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13055 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13056 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13057 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13058 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13059 sample fetch keyword.
13060
13061table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13062 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13063 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13064 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
13065 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13066 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13067
13068table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13069 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13070 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13071 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13072 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13073 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13074 keyword.
13075
13076table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13077 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13078 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13079 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
13080 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13081 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13082
13083table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13084 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13085 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13086 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13087 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13088 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13089 keyword.
13090
13091table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13092 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13093 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13094 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
13095 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13096 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13097 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13098 keyword.
13099
13100table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13101 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13102 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13103 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
13104 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13105 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13106 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13107 keyword.
13108
13109table_server_id(<table>)
13110 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13111 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13112 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13113 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13114 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13115 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13116
13117table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13118 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13119 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13120 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
13121 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13122 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13123 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13124 keyword.
13125
13126table_sess_rate(<table>)
13127 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13128 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13129 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13130 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13131 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13132 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13133 keyword.
13134
13135table_trackers(<table>)
13136 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13137 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13138 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13139 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13140 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13141 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13142 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13143 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13144 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13145 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13146
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013147upper
13148 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13149 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13150 type. The result is of type string.
13151
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013152url_dec
13153 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13154 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13155
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013156unset-var(<var name>)
13157 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13158 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13159 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13160 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13161 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13162 response),
13163 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13164 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13165 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13166 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13167
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013168utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13169 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13170 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13171 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13172 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13173 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13174 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13175
13176 Example :
13177
13178 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
13179 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
13180 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13181
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013182word(<index>,<delimiters>)
13183 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
13184 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13185
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013186wt6([<avalanche>])
13187 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13188 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13189 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13190 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13191 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13192 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13193 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013194 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
13195 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013196
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013197xor(<value>)
13198 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013199 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013200 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013201 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013202 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013203 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13204 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013205 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013206 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13207 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013208 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013209 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013210
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013211xxh32([<seed>])
13212 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13213 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13214 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13215 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13216 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13217 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13218 as cryptographically secure.
13219
13220xxh64([<seed>])
13221 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13222 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13223 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13224 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13225 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13226 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13227 as cryptographically secure.
13228
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013229
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200132307.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013231--------------------------------------------
13232
13233A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13234not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13235"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13236The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13237
13238always_false : boolean
13239 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13240 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13241
13242always_true : boolean
13243 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13244 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13245
13246avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013247 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013248 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13249 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13250 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13251 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13252 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13253 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13254 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13255 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13256 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13257 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13258 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13259 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13260 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013262be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013263 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13264 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13265 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13266 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
13267 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013269be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13270 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13271 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13272 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
13273 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
13274 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13275 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013276
13277 Example :
13278 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13279 backend dynamic
13280 mode http
13281 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13282 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013283
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013284bin(<hexa>) : bin
13285 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13286 of the string.
13287
13288bool(<bool>) : bool
13289 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13290 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013292connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13293 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013294 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013295 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13296 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013297
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013298 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013299 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013300 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13301
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013302 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13303 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013304
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013305 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013306 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013307 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013308 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
13309 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013310 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013311 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013312
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013313 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13314 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013315 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013316 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013317
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013318date([<offset>]) : integer
13319 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13320 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13321 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13322 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013323 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13324
13325 Example :
13326
13327 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13328 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013329
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020013330distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
13331 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
13332 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
13333 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
13334 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
13335 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
13336 list of supported tokens.
13337
13338distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
13339 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
13340 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
13341 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
13342 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
13343 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
13344 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
13345 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
13346 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
13347 supported tokens.
13348
13349 Example :
13350 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
13351 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
13352 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
13353 # send large files to the big farm
13354 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
13355
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013356env(<name>) : string
13357 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13358 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13359 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13360 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13361 certain way.
13362
13363 Examples :
13364 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13365 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13366
13367 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13368 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013370fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13371 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013372 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13373 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013374 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13375 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
13376 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
13377 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13378 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013379
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013380fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13381 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13382 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13383 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013385fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13386 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13387 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13388 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13389 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13390 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13391 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13392 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13393 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013394
13395 Example :
13396 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13397 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13398 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13399 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13400 frontend mail
13401 bind :25
13402 mode tcp
13403 maxconn 100
13404 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13405 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13406 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13407 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013408
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013409hostname : string
13410 Returns the system hostname.
13411
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013412int(<integer>) : signed integer
13413 Returns a signed integer.
13414
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013415ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13416 Returns an ipv4.
13417
13418ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13419 Returns an ipv6.
13420
13421meth(<method>) : method
13422 Returns a method.
13423
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013424nbproc : integer
13425 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13426 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13427 and debugging purposes.
13428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013429nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13430 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13431 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13432 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013433 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13434 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13435 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013436
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013437proc : integer
13438 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13439 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13440 debugging purposes.
13441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013442queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013443 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13444 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13445 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013446 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13447 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13448 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13449 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13450 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13451
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013452rand([<range>]) : integer
13453 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13454 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13455 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13456 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13457 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013459srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13460 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13461 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13462 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13463 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13464 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13465 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13466 methods.
13467
13468srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13469 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13470 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13471 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13472 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13473 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13474 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13475 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13476
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020013477srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13478 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
13479 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
13480 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
13481 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
13482 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
13483 fetch methods.
13484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013485srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13486 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13487 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013488 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013489 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13490 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13491 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13492 overloading servers).
13493
13494 Example :
13495 # Redirect to a separate back
13496 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13497 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13498 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13499
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013500stopping : boolean
13501 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13502 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13503 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13504
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013505str(<string>) : string
13506 Returns a string.
13507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013508table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13509 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13510 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13511
13512table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13513 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13514 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13515 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13516
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013517var(<var-name>) : undefined
13518 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013519 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13520 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013521 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013522 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13523 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013524 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013525 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13526 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013527 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013528 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013529
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200135307.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013531----------------------------------
13532
13533The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13534closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13535methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13536sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13537TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013538the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13539counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13540"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013541argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13542the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13543this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013544
13545be_id : integer
13546 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13547 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13548
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013549be_name : string
13550 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13551 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013553dst : ip
13554 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13555 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13556 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13557 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13558 RFC 4291.
13559
13560dst_conn : integer
13561 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13562 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13563 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13564 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13565 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13566 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13567 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13568 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013569
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013570dst_is_local : boolean
13571 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13572 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13573 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13574 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13575 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13576 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13577 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13578 it only once per connection.
13579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013580dst_port : integer
13581 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13582 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13583 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13584 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13585 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13586 an HTTP header.
13587
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013588fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13589 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13590 header.
13591
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013592fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13593 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13594 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13595 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13596 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13597 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13598 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13599
13600fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13601 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13602 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13603 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13604 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13605 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13606 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13607
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013608fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13609 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13610 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13611 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13612 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13613
13614fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13615 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13616 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13617 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13618 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13619
13620fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13621 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13622 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13623 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13624 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13625
13626fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13627 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13628 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13629 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13630 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13631
13632fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13633 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13634 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13635 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13636 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13637
13638fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13639 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13640 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13641 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13642 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013644fe_id : integer
13645 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013646 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013647 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13648
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013649fe_name : string
13650 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13651 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13652 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13653
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013654sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013655sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13656sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13657sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013658 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13659 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13660 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13661
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013662sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013663sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13664sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13665sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013666 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13667 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13668 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13669
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013670sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013671sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13672sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13673sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013674 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13675 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013676 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13677 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13678 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013679
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013680 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013681 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13682 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013683 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13684 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13685 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013686 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13687 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13688
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013689sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013690sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13691sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13692sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013693 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13694 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13695
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013696sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013697sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13698sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13699sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013700 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13701 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13702 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13703
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013704sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013705sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13706sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13707sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013708 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13709 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13710 See also src_conn_rate.
13711
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013712sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013713sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13714sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13715sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013716 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013717 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013718
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013719sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13720sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13721sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13722sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13723 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13724 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13725
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013726sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013727sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13728sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13729sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013730 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13731 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13732 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013733 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13734 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13735 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013736
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013737sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013738sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13739sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13740sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013741 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13742 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13743 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13744
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013745sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013746sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13747sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13748sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013749 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13750 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13751 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13752 src_http_err_rate.
13753
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013754sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013755sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13756sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13757sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013758 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13759 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13760 src_http_req_cnt.
13761
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013762sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013763sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13764sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13765sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013766 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13767 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13768 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13769 src_http_req_rate.
13770
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013771sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013772sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13773sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13774sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013775 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013776 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13777 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13778 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13779 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013780
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013781 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013782 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13783 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013784 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13785
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013786sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013787sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13788sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13789sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013790 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13791 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13792 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013793
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013794sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013795sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13796sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13797sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013798 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13799 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13800 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013801
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013802sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013803sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13804sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13805sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013806 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13807 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13808 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13809 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013810 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013811 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13812
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013813sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013814sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13815sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13816sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013817 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13818 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13819 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13820 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13821 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013822 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013823
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013824sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013825sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13826sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13827sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013828 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13829 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13830 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13831
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013832sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013833sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13834sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13835sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013836 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13837 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013838 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013839 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13840 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013841 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13842 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13843 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013845so_id : integer
13846 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13847 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13848 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013850src : ip
13851 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13852 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13853 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13854 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013855 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13856 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13857 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13858 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013859
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013860 Example:
13861 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13862 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013864src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13865 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13866 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13867 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013868 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013870src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13871 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13872 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013873 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013874 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013876src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13877 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13878 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13879 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13880 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13881 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13882 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013883
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013884 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013885 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13886 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13887 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13888 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013889 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013890 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13891 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013893src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013894 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013895 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013896 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013897 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013899src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013900 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013901 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13902 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013903 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013905src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13906 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13907 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13908 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013909 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013911src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013912 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013913 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013914 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013915 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013916
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013917src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13918 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13919 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13920 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13921 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013923src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013924 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013925 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013926 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13927 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013928 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13929 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13930 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013932src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13933 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13934 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013935 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013936 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013937 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013939src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13940 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13941 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13942 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13943 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013944 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013946src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13947 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13948 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13949 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013950 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013952src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13953 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13954 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13955 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013956 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013957 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013959src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13960 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13961 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13962 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013963 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013964 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13965 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013966
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013967 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013968 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013969 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013970 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013971
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013972src_is_local : boolean
13973 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13974 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13975 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13976 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13977 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13978 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13979 once per connection.
13980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013981src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013982 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13983 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13984 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13985 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13986 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013988src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013989 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13990 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13991 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13992 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13993 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013995src_port : integer
13996 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13997 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13998 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13999 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014001src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14002 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014003 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14004 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14005 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014006 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014008src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14009 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14010 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14011 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14012 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014013 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014015src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14016 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14017 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14018 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14019 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14020 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14021 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14022 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14023 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014024
14025 Example :
14026 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
14027 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
14028 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
14029 listen ssh
14030 bind :22
14031 mode tcp
14032 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014033 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014034 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014035 server local 127.0.0.1:22
14036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014037srv_id : integer
14038 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
14039 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14040 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020014041
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140427.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014043----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020014044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014045The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
14046closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
14047when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
14048usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014049future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014050
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001405151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
14052 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14053 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14054 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
14055 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14056 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14057
14058 Example :
14059 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
14060 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
14061 # the request.
14062 frontend http-in
14063 bind *:8081
14064 default_backend servers
14065 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14066 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14067
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014068ssl_bc : boolean
14069 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14070 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
14071 other a server with the "ssl" option.
14072
14073ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
14074 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
14075 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14076
14077ssl_bc_cipher : string
14078 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
14079 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14080
14081ssl_bc_protocol : string
14082 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
14083 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14084
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014085ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014086 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014087 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14088 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014089
14090ssl_bc_session_id : binary
14091 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
14092 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
14093 if session was reused or not.
14094
14095ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
14096 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
14097 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014099ssl_c_ca_err : integer
14100 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14101 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
14102 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
14103 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
14104 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014106ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
14107 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14108 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
14109 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
14110 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014111
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014112ssl_c_der : binary
14113 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
14114 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14115 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014117ssl_c_err : integer
14118 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14119 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
14120 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
14121 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
14122 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014124ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14125 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14126 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14127 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14128 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14129 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14130 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14131 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14132 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014134ssl_c_key_alg : string
14135 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14136 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14137 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014139ssl_c_notafter : string
14140 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
14141 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14142 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014144ssl_c_notbefore : string
14145 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
14146 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14147 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014149ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14150 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14151 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14152 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14153 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14154 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14155 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14156 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14157 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014159ssl_c_serial : binary
14160 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
14161 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14162 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014164ssl_c_sha1 : binary
14165 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
14166 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
14167 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014168 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
14169 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
14170
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014171 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014172 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014174ssl_c_sig_alg : string
14175 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14176 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14177 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014179ssl_c_used : boolean
14180 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
14181 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014183ssl_c_verify : integer
14184 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
14185 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
14186 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
14187 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014189ssl_c_version : integer
14190 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
14191 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014192
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014193ssl_f_der : binary
14194 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
14195 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14196 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014198ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14199 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14200 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14201 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14202 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014203 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014204 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14205 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14206 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014208ssl_f_key_alg : string
14209 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14210 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
14211 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014213ssl_f_notafter : string
14214 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14215 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14216 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014218ssl_f_notbefore : string
14219 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14220 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14221 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014223ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14224 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14225 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14226 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14227 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14228 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14229 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14230 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14231 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014233ssl_f_serial : binary
14234 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14235 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14236 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014237
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020014238ssl_f_sha1 : binary
14239 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
14240 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
14241 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
14242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014243ssl_f_sig_alg : string
14244 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14245 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14246 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014248ssl_f_version : integer
14249 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14250 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14251
14252ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014253 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14254 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
14255 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
14256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014257 Example :
14258 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
14259 listen http-https
14260 bind :80
14261 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
14262 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
14263
14264ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
14265 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
14266 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14267
14268ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014269 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014270 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
14271 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
14272 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14273 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14274 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
14275 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
14276 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14277 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
14278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014279ssl_fc_cipher : string
14280 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
14281 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014282
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014283ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
14284 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
14285 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014286 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014287
14288ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14289 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14290 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014291 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014292
14293ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14294 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14295 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14296 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020014297 avaible with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
14298 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014299
14300ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14301 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14302 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014303 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014305ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014306 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14307 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014308 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14309 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14310 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14311 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014312
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020014313ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
14314 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
14315 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
14316 wait until the handshake happened.
14317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014318ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14319 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014320 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14321 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14322 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14323 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014324
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014325ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014326 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
14327 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
14328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014329ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014330 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014331 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14332 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14333 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14334 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14335 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14336 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14337 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014339ssl_fc_protocol : string
14340 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14341 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014342
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014343ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014344 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014345 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14346 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014348ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14349 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14350 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14351 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14352 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014354ssl_fc_sni : string
14355 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14356 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14357 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14358 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14359 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14360
14361 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14362 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14363 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014364 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14365 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014367 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014368 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14369 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014371ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14372 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14373 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014374
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014375
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200143767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014377------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014379Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14380sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14381only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14382For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14383be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14384can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14385sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14386for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14387content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014389payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
14390 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
14391 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14392 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014394payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14395 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
14396 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
14397 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014398
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020014399req.hdrs : string
14400 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
14401 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
14402 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
14403 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
14404
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020014405req.hdrs_bin : binary
14406 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
14407 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
14408 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
14409 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
14410 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
14411 names and values (length of 0 for both).
14412
14413 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
14414
14415 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
14416 str: <int:length><bytes>
14417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014418req.len : integer
14419req_len : integer (deprecated)
14420 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14421 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14422 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14423 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14424 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14425 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14426 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14427 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014429req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14430 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014431 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14432 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14433 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14434 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014436 ACL alternatives :
14437 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014439req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14440 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14441 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14442 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14443 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014445 ACL alternatives :
14446 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014448 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014450req.proto_http : boolean
14451req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14452 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14453 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14454 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14455 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14456 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14457 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14458 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014460 Example:
14461 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14462 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14463 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014464 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014466req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14467rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14468 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14469 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14470 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14471 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14472 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14473 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14474 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014476 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14477 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14478 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14479 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14480 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14481 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014483 ACL derivatives :
14484 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014486 Example :
14487 listen tse-farm
14488 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14489 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14490 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14491 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14492 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14493 persist rdp-cookie
14494 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14495 # This is only useful makes sense if
14496 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14497 stick-table type string size 204800
14498 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14499 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14500 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014502 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14503 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014505req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14506rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14507 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14508 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14509 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14510 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014512 ACL derivatives :
14513 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014514
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014515req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14516 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14517 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014518 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14519 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14520 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14521 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14522 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014524req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14525req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14526 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14527 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14528 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14529 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14530 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14531 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14532 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014534req.ssl_sni : string
14535req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14536 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14537 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14538 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14539 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14540 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14541 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14542 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14543 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14544 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14545 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14546 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14547 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014549 ACL derivatives :
14550 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014552 Examples :
14553 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14554 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14555 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14556 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14557 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014558
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014559req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14560 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14561 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14562 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14563 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14564 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14565 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14566 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14567 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14568 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014570req.ssl_ver : integer
14571req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14572 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14573 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14574 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14575 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14576 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14577 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14578 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14579 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14580 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014582 ACL derivatives :
14583 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014584
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014585res.len : integer
14586 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14587 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14588 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14589 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14590 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14591 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14592 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14593 content inspection.
14594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014595res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14596 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014597 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14598 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14599 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14600 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014602res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14603 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14604 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14605 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14606 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014608 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014609
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014610res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14611rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14612 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14613 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14614 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14615 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14616 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14617 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14618 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014620wait_end : boolean
14621 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14622 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14623 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14624 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14625 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14626 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14627 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14628 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014630 Examples :
14631 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14632 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14633 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014635 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14636 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14637 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14638 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14639 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14640 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14641 tcp-request content reject
14642
14643
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146447.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014645--------------------------------------
14646
14647It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14648This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14649data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14650its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14651HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14652content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14653to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14654more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14655response are indexed.
14656
14657base : string
14658 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14659 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14660 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14661 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14662 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14663 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14664 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14665 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14666
14667 ACL derivatives :
14668 base : exact string match
14669 base_beg : prefix match
14670 base_dir : subdir match
14671 base_dom : domain match
14672 base_end : suffix match
14673 base_len : length match
14674 base_reg : regex match
14675 base_sub : substring match
14676
14677base32 : integer
14678 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14679 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14680 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014681 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14682 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14683 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014684
14685base32+src : binary
14686 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14687 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14688 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14689 per-URL counters.
14690
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014691capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14692 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14693 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14694 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14695
14696capture.req.method : string
14697 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14698 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14699 because it's allocated.
14700
14701capture.req.uri : string
14702 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14703 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14704 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14705 allocated.
14706
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014707capture.req.ver : string
14708 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14709 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14710 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14711
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014712capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14713 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14714 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14715 The first entry is an index of 0.
14716 See also: "capture response header"
14717
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014718capture.res.ver : string
14719 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14720 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14721 persistent flag.
14722
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014723req.body : binary
14724 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14725 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14726 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14727 the first chunk is analyzed.
14728
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014729req.body_param([<name>) : string
14730 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14731 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14732 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14733 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14734 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14735 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14736 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14737 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14738 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14739 given.
14740
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014741req.body_len : integer
14742 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14743 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14744 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14745 "option http-buffer-request".
14746
14747req.body_size : integer
14748 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14749 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14750 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14751 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14752 "option http-buffer-request".
14753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014754req.cook([<name>]) : string
14755cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14756 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14757 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14758 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14759 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14760 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14761 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14762 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14763 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14764
14765 ACL derivatives :
14766 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14767 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14768 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14769 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14770 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14771 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14772 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14773 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014775req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14776cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14777 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14778 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014780req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14781cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14782 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14783 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14784 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14785 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014787cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14788 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14789 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14790 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14791 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014792 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014793 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14794 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14795 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14796 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014798hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14799 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14800 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14801 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14802 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014803 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014805req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14806 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14807 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14808 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14809 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14810 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14811 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14812 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14813 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014815req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14816 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14817 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14818 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14819 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014821req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14822 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14823 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14824 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14825 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14826 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14827 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14828 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14829 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000014830 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014831 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14832 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014834 ACL derivatives :
14835 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14836 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14837 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14838 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14839 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14840 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14841 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14842 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14843
14844req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14845hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14846 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14847 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14848 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14849 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14850 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14851 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14852 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14853 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14854 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14855
14856req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14857hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14858 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14859 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14860 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14861 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14862 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14863 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14864 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14865 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14866
14867req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14868hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14869 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14870 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14871 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14872 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14873 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14874 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14875 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14876
14877http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14878 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14879 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14880 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14881 basic auth is supported.
14882
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014883http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14884 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14885 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14886 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14887 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014888 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14889 basic auth is supported.
14890
14891 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014892 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14893 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14894 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14895 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014896
14897http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014898 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14899 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014900 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14901 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014903method : integer + string
14904 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14905 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14906 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14907 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14908 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14909 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14910 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014912 ACL derivatives :
14913 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014915 Example :
14916 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14917 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14918 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014920path : string
14921 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14922 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14923 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14924 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14925 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14926 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14927 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014929 ACL derivatives :
14930 path : exact string match
14931 path_beg : prefix match
14932 path_dir : subdir match
14933 path_dom : domain match
14934 path_end : suffix match
14935 path_len : length match
14936 path_reg : regex match
14937 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014938
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014939query : string
14940 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14941 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14942 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14943 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014944 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014945 which stops before the question mark.
14946
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014947req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14948 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14949 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14950 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14951 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014953req.ver : string
14954req_ver : string (deprecated)
14955 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14956 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14957 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014959 ACL derivatives :
14960 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014962res.comp : boolean
14963 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14964 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14965 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014967res.comp_algo : string
14968 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14969 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14970 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014972res.cook([<name>]) : string
14973scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14974 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14975 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14976 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014978 ACL derivatives :
14979 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014981res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14982scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14983 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14984 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14985 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014987res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14988scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14989 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14990 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14991 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014993res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14994 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14995 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14996 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14997 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14998 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14999 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
15000 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
15001 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
15002 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015004res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15005 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15006 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15007 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15008 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
15009 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015011res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15012shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
15013 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15014 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15015 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15016 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15017 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
15018 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
15019 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
15020 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015022 ACL derivatives :
15023 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15024 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15025 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15026 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15027 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15028 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15029 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15030 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15031
15032res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15033shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15034 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15035 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15036 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
15037 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
15038 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015040res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15041shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15042 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
15043 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
15044 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
15045 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
15046 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
15047 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015048
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015049res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15050 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15051 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15052 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15053 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015055res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15056shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15057 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
15058 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15059 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
15060 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
15061 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
15062 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015064res.ver : string
15065resp_ver : string (deprecated)
15066 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
15067 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015069 ACL derivatives :
15070 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015072set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15073 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15074 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015075 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015076 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015078 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
15079 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015081status : integer
15082 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
15083 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
15084 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015085
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020015086unique-id : string
15087 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
15088 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
15089 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
15090 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
15091 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
15092 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
15093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015094url : string
15095 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
15096 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
15097 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
15098 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
15099 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
15100 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
15101 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015103 ACL derivatives :
15104 url : exact string match
15105 url_beg : prefix match
15106 url_dir : subdir match
15107 url_dom : domain match
15108 url_end : suffix match
15109 url_len : length match
15110 url_reg : regex match
15111 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015113url_ip : ip
15114 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
15115 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
15116 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
15117 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
15118 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
15119 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15120 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015122url_port : integer
15123 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
15124 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
15125 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15126 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015127
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015128urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
15129url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015130 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
15131 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015132 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
15133 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
15134 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
15135 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015136 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
15137 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015138 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
15139 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015141 ACL derivatives :
15142 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
15143 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
15144 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
15145 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
15146 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
15147 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
15148 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
15149 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015150
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015152 Example :
15153 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
15154 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
15155 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
15156 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015157
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015158urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015159 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
15160 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
15161 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020015162
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020015163url32 : integer
15164 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
15165 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
15166 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
15167 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
15168 is an unsigned integer.
15169
15170url32+src : binary
15171 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
15172 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
15173 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
15174
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010015175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200151767.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015177---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015179Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
15180every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020015181order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015182
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015183ACL name Equivalent to Usage
15184---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015185FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020015186HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015187HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
15188HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015189HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
15190HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
15191HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
15192HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
15193LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015194METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015195METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015196METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
15197METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
15198METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
15199METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015200METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015201METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015202RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015203REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015204TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015205WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
15206---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015207
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010015208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152098. Logging
15210----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015211
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015212One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
15213provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
15214very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
15215provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
15216state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015217to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015218headers.
15219
15220In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
15221about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
15222send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
15223
15224 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
15225 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
15226 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
15227 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
15228 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060015229 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
15230 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015231
15232The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
15233allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
15234as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
15235while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
15236real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
15237delay.
15238
15239
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152408.1. Log levels
15241---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015242
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015243TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015244source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015245HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
15246in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
15247track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
15248syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
15249about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015250
15251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152528.2. Log formats
15253----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015254
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015255HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015256and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
15257slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
15258options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015259
15260 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
15261 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
15262 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
15263 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
15264 extents.
15265
15266 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
15267 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
15268 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
15269 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
15270 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
15271
15272 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
15273 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
15274 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
15275 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
15276 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
15277
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020015278 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
15279 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
15280 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
15281 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
15282
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015283 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
15284
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015285Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
15286specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
15287field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
15288servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
15289always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
15290identifier.
15291
15292Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
15293 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
15294 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
15295 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
15296 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
15297
15298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152998.2.1. Default log format
15300-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015301
15302This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
15303as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
15304format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
15305
15306 Example :
15307 listen www
15308 mode http
15309 log global
15310 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15311
15312 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15313 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15314 (www/HTTP)
15315
15316 Field Format Extract from the example above
15317 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15318 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15319 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15320 4 'to' to
15321 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15322 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15323
15324Detailed fields description :
15325 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15326 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15327 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15328 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15329 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15330 and processed the connection.
15331 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15332
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015333In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15334"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15335connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15336
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015337It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15338will eventually disappear.
15339
15340
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153418.2.2. TCP log format
15342---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015343
15344The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15345is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15346information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15347counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15348emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15349environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15350the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15351sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015352specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15353not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15354fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15355marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015356
15357 Example :
15358 frontend fnt
15359 mode tcp
15360 option tcplog
15361 log global
15362 default_backend bck
15363
15364 backend bck
15365 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15366
15367 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15368 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15369 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15370
15371 Field Format Extract from the example above
15372 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15373 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
15374 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
15375 4 frontend_name fnt
15376 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
15377 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15378 7 bytes_read* 212
15379 8 termination_state --
15380 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15381 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15382
15383Detailed fields description :
15384 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015385 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15386 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15387 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015388 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15389 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15390 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015391
15392 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015393 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15394 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15395 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015396
15397 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15398 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15399 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
15400 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
15401
15402 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15403 and processed the connection.
15404
15405 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15406 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15407 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15408 applications.
15409
15410 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15411 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15412 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15413 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15414 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15415
15416 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15417 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15418 See "Timers" below for more details.
15419
15420 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15421 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15422 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15423 "Timers" below for more details.
15424
15425 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015426 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015427 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15428 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15429 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15430 details.
15431
15432 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15433 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15434 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15435 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15436 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15437
15438 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15439 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15440 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15441 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15442 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15443 for more details.
15444
15445 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015446 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015447 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15448 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15449 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015450 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015451
15452 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15453 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15454 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15455 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15456 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15457 caused by a denial of service attack.
15458
15459 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15460 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15461 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15462 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15463 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15464 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15465 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15466 denial of service attack.
15467
15468 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15469 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15470 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15471 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15472 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15473 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15474 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15475 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15476 be processed than on other servers.
15477
15478 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15479 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15480 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15481 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15482 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15483 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15484 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15485 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15486 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15487 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15488 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15489 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15490 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15491
15492 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15493 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15494 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15495 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15496 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15497 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15498 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15499 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15500
15501 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15502 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15503 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15504 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15505 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15506 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15507 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15508 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15509 occurs.
15510
15511
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155128.2.3. HTTP log format
15513----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015514
15515The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15516is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15517the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15518are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15519emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15520generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15521"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15522which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015523frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15524is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015525
15526Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15527slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15528with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15529
15530 Example :
15531 frontend http-in
15532 mode http
15533 option httplog
15534 log global
15535 default_backend bck
15536
15537 backend static
15538 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15539
15540 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15541 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15542 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015543 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015544
15545 Field Format Extract from the example above
15546 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15547 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015548 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015549 4 frontend_name http-in
15550 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015551 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015552 7 status_code 200
15553 8 bytes_read* 2750
15554 9 captured_request_cookie -
15555 10 captured_response_cookie -
15556 11 termination_state ----
15557 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15558 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15559 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15560 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15561 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015562
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015563Detailed fields description :
15564 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015565 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15566 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15567 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015568 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15569 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15570 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015571
15572 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015573 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15574 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15575 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015576
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015577 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15578 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015579
15580 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15581 and processed the connection.
15582
15583 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15584 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15585 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15586
15587 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15588 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15589 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15590 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15591 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15592 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15593
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015594 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15595 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15596 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15597 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15598 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15599 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15600 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015601
15602 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15603 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15604 See "Timers" below for more details.
15605
15606 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15607 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15608 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15609 below for more details.
15610
15611 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15612 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15613 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15614 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15615 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15616 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15617 for more details.
15618
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015619 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15620 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15621 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15622 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15623 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15624 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15625 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15626 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015627
15628 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15629 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15630 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15631
15632 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15633 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15634 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15635 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15636 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15637 overflowing.
15638
15639 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15640 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15641 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15642 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15643 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15644 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15645 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15646 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15647
15648 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15649 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15650 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15651 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15652 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15653 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15654 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15655 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15656
15657 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15658 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15659 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15660 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15661 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15662 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15663 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15664
15665 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015666 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015667 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15668 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15669 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015670 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015671 system.
15672
15673 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15674 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15675 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15676 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15677 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15678 caused by a denial of service attack.
15679
15680 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15681 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15682 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15683 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15684 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15685 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15686 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15687 denial of service attack.
15688
15689 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15690 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15691 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15692 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15693 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15694 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15695 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15696 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15697 processed than on other servers.
15698
15699 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15700 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15701 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15702 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15703 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15704 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15705 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15706 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15707 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15708 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15709 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15710 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15711 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15712
15713 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15714 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15715 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15716 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15717 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15718 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15719 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15720 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15721
15722 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15723 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15724 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15725 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15726 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15727 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15728 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15729 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15730 occurs.
15731
15732 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15733 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15734 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15735 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15736 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15737 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15738 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15739 cookies" below for more details.
15740
15741 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15742 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15743 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15744 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15745 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15746 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15747 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15748 and cookies" below for more details.
15749
15750 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15751 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15752 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15753 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15754 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15755 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15756 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15757 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15758
15759
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200157608.2.4. Custom log format
15761------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015762
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015763The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015764mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015765
15766HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15767Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15768separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15769prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15770
15771Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15772variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015773("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015774
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015775If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015776as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015777less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15778the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15779
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015780Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015781In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015782in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015783
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015784Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15785'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15786https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15787such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15788
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015789Flags are :
15790 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015791 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015792 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15793 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015794
15795 Example:
15796
15797 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15798 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15799
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015800 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15801
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015802At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15803
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015804 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15805 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015806
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015807the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015808
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015809 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15810 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15811 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015812
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015813and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15814
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015815 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15816 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015817
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015818Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15819
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015820 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015821 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015822 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15823 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15824 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015825 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15826 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15827 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015828 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015829 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15830 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015831 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015832 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15833 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015834 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015835 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015836 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015837 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015838 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015839 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015840 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015841 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15842 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15843 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15844 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15845 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015846 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015847 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15848 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015849 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015850 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15851 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015852 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15853 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15854 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015855 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015856 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15857 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015858 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015859 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15860 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15861 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015862 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015863 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015864 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15865 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15866 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15867 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015868 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015869 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015870 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015871 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015872 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015873 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015874 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15875 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15876 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015877 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015878 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15879 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015880 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015881 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15882 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15883 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015884 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015885 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015886 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015887
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015888 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015889
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015890
158918.2.5. Error log format
15892-----------------------
15893
15894When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15895protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15896By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15897"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15898will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15899logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15900
15901The format looks like this :
15902
15903 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15904 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15905 Connection error during SSL handshake
15906
15907 Field Format Extract from the example above
15908 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15909 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15910 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15911 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15912 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15913
15914These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15915failures.
15916
15917
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159188.3. Advanced logging options
15919-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015920
15921Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15922just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15923options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15924for more information about their usage.
15925
15926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159278.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15928------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015929
15930It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15931haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15932commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15933monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15934ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15935
15936 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15937 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15938 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15939 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15940
15941 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15942 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15943 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015944 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015945 such as other load-balancers.
15946
15947 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15948 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15949 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15950
15951
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159528.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15953----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015954
15955The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15956what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15957or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15958"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15959just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15960log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15961after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15962is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15963with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15964with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15965
15966
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159678.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15968------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015969
15970Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15971for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15972"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15973retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15974raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15975a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15976file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15977you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15978"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15979
15980
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159818.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15982--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015983
15984Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15985multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15986them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15987"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15988logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15989error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
15990and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15991too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15992useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15993alternative.
15994
15995
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159968.4. Timing events
15997------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015998
15999Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
16000reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
16001the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
16002frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016003mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
16004addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
16005
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010016006Timings events in HTTP mode:
16007
16008 first request 2nd request
16009 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
16010 t tr t tr ...
16011 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
16012 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
16013 :<---- Tq ---->: :
16014 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
16015 :<--------- Ta --------->:
16016
16017Timings events in TCP mode:
16018
16019 TCP session
16020 |<----------------->|
16021 t t
16022 ---|----|----|----|----|---
16023 | Th Tw Tc Td |
16024 |<------ Tt ------->|
16025
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016026 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
16027 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
16028 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
16029 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
16030 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
16031 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
16032 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016033
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016034 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
16035 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
16036 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
16037 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
16038 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
16039 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
16040 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
16041 nothing was received on the connection.
16042
16043 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
16044 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
16045 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
16046 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
16047 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
16048 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
16049 request typed by hand during a test.
16050
16051 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
16052 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
16053 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
16054 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
16055 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
16056 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
16057 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016058
16059 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
16060 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
16061 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
16062 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
16063 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
16064
16065 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
16066 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
16067 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
16068 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
16069 connection never established.
16070
16071 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
16072 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
16073 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
16074 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
16075 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
16076 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
16077 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
16078 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
16079 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
16080 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
16081 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
16082
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016083 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
16084 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
16085 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
16086 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
16087 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
16088 by subtracting other timers when valid :
16089
16090 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
16091
16092 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
16093 "Ta" can never be negative.
16094
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016095 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
16096 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016097 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
16098 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016099 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016100
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016101 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016102
16103 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016104 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
16105 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016106
16107These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
16108protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
16109that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016110due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
16111"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
16112that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016113
16114Most common cases :
16115
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016116 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
16117 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
16118 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
16119 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
16120 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
16121 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
16122 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
16123 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
16124 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
16125 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
16126 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020016127 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016128
16129 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
16130 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
16131 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
16132 of ms on remote networks.
16133
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016134 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
16135 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
16136 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016137
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016138 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
16139 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
16140 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
16141 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
16142 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
16143 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
16144 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
16145 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
16146 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016147
16148Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
16149
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016150 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016151 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016152 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016153
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016154 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016155 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
16156 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
16157
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016158 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016159 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
16160 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
16161 flags.
16162
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016163 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
16164 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016165 Check the session termination flags, then check the
16166 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
16167 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
16168 the client connection was maintained open.
16169
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016170 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016171 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016172 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016173 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
16174
16175
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161768.5. Session state at disconnection
16177-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016178
16179TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
16180"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
161812-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
16182each of which has a special meaning :
16183
16184 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
16185 session to terminate :
16186
16187 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
16188
16189 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
16190 server explicitly refused it.
16191
16192 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
16193 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
16194 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
16195 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016196 (eg: cacheable cookie).
16197
16198 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
16199 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016200
16201 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
16202 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
16203 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
16204 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
16205 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
16206
16207 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
16208 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
16209 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
16210 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
16211 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
16212
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090016213 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
16214 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
16215
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016216 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
16217 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
16218 backup connections when going up.
16219
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020016220 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
16221
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016222 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
16223 send or receive data.
16224
16225 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
16226 send or receive data.
16227
16228 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
16229 with nothing left in the buffers.
16230
16231 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
16232
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010016233 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016234 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
16235
16236 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
16237 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
16238 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
16239 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
16240 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
16241
16242 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
16243 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
16244
16245 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
16246 server (HTTP only).
16247
16248 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
16249
16250 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
16251 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
16252 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
16253
16254 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
16255 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
16256 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
16257
16258 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
16259
16260 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
16261 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
16262
16263 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
16264 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
16265 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
16266
16267 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
16268 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020016269 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
16270 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016271
16272 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
16273 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
16274 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
16275 another server.
16276
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016277 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016278 server.
16279
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016280 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
16281 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
16282 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
16283 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16284
16285 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
16286 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
16287 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
16288 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16289
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020016290 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
16291 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
16292 "use-server" rule).
16293
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016294 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16295
16296 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
16297 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
16298
16299 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
16300
16301 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
16302 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
16303 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
16304
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016305 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
16306 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016307 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016308 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
16309 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16310
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016311 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16312
16313 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16314 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16315
16316 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16317
16318 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16319
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016320The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16321was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016322helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16323starvation, attacks, etc...
16324
16325The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16326alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16327easier finding and understanding.
16328
16329 Flags Reason
16330
16331 -- Normal termination.
16332
16333 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16334 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16335 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16336 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16337
16338 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16339 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16340 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16341 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16342 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16343 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016344
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016345 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16346 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016347 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016348
16349 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16350 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16351 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16352
16353 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16354 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16355 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16356 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16357 the server takes too long to respond.
16358
16359 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16360 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16361 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16362 long a time to respond.
16363
16364 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16365 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
16366 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
16367 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016368 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
16369 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016370
16371 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
16372 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
16373 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
16374 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
16375 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020016376 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016377 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16378 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16379 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16380 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16381 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16382 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16383 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16384 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
16385 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
16386 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16387 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16388 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016389
16390 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16391 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016392 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16393 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16394 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16395 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016396
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016397 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16398 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16399
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016400 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016401 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16402 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
16403 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
16404 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16405 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16406
16407 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16408 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16409 503 or 504 here.
16410
16411 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16412 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16413 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
16414 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
16415 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16416
16417 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16418 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016419 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016420 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16421 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16422
16423 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16424 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16425 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16426 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16427 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16428 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16429 between haproxy and the server.
16430
16431 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16432 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16433 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16434 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16435 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16436 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16437 solution is to fix the application.
16438
16439 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16440 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16441 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16442 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16443 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16444 external attacks.
16445
16446 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16447 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016448 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016449 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16450 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16451
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016452 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16453 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16454 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016455 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
16456 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016457
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016458 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16459 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16460 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16461 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016462 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16463 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16464 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16465 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16466 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016467
16468 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16469 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16470 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16471 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16472
16473 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16474 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16475 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16476 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16477
16478 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16479 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16480 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16481 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16482
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016483The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16484persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16485important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16486re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16487
16488 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16489
16490 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16491 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16492 set on a GET request.
16493
16494 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16495 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016496 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016497 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16498
16499 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16500 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16501 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16502
16503 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16504 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16505 already got a cookie.
16506
16507 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16508 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16509 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16510 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16511 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16512
16513 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16514 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16515 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16516
16517 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16518 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16519 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16520
16521 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16522 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16523
16524 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16525 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16526 then advertised in the response.
16527
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016528
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165298.6. Non-printable characters
16530-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016531
16532In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16533consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16534converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16535prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16536being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16537escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16538is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16539'}' when logging headers.
16540
16541Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16542issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16543containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16544
16545Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16546the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16547performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16548
16549
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165508.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16551---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016552
16553Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16554achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016555section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016556cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16557the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16558the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016559locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016560not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16561user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16562a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16563wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16564
16565 Examples :
16566 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16567 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16568
16569 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16570 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16571
16572
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165738.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16574---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016575
16576Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16577proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16578the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16579server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16580
16581Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16582response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016583section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016584
16585It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016586time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16587appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016588are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16589and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16590follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16591request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16592in the logs.
16593
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016594As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16595frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16596an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16597
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016598 Example :
16599 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16600 listen proxy-out
16601 mode http
16602 option httplog
16603 option logasap
16604 log global
16605 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16606
16607 # log the name of the virtual server
16608 capture request header Host len 20
16609
16610 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16611 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16612
16613 # log the beginning of the referrer
16614 capture request header Referer len 20
16615
16616 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16617 capture response header Server len 20
16618
16619 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16620 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16621
16622 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16623 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16624
16625 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16626 capture response header Via len 20
16627
16628 # log the URL location during a redirection
16629 capture response header Location len 20
16630
16631 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16632 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16633 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16634 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16635 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16636
16637 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16638 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16639 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16640 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016641 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016642
16643 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16644 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16645 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16646 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16647 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016648 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016649
16650
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166518.9. Examples of logs
16652---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016653
16654These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16655them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16656reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16657
16658 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16659 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16660 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16661
16662 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16663 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16664
16665 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16666 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16667 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16668
16669 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16670 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16671
16672 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16673 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16674 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16675
16676 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016677 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016678 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16679 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16680
16681 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16682 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16683 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16684
16685 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16686 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016687 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016688 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16689 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16690 to return the 502 and not the server.
16691
16692 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016693 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016694
16695 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16696 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16697 Nothing was sent to any server.
16698
16699 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16700 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16701
16702 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16703 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16704 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16705 send a 408 return code to the client.
16706
16707 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16708 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16709
16710 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16711 5 seconds ("c----").
16712
16713 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16714 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016715 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016716
16717 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016718 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016719 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16720 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16721 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16722 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16723 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016724
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016725
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200167269. Supported filters
16727--------------------
16728
16729Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16730accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16731unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16732
16733See also : "filter"
16734
167359.1. Trace
16736----------
16737
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016738filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016739
16740 Arguments:
16741 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16742 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16743
16744 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16745 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16746 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16747 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16748
16749 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16750 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16751 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16752 amount of the parsed data.
16753
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016754 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16755
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016756This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16757callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16758information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16759filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16760
16761Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16762tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16763a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16764
16765
167669.2. HTTP compression
16767---------------------
16768
16769filter compression
16770
16771The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16772keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16773when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16774use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16775used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16776filters evaluation order.
16777
16778See also : "compression"
16779
16780
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200167819.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16782--------------------------------------------
16783
16784filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16785
16786 Arguments :
16787
16788 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16789 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16790 parsed.
16791
16792 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16793 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16794 part must be placed in its own scope.
16795
16796The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16797external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16798streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16799exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16800also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16801
16802SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16803the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16804
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016805For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016806"doc/SPOE.txt".
16807
16808Important note:
16809 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16810 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16811
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016812/*
16813 * Local variables:
16814 * fill-column: 79
16815 * End:
16816 */